*** empty log message ***
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111 \f
112 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
113
114 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
115 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
116 the fancy startup screen.
117
118 +++
119 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
120 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
121 the blinking cursor.
122
123 +++
124 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
125 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
126
127 +++
128 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
129 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
130 can start with this line:
131
132 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
133
134 +++
135 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
136 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
137 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
138
139 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
140
141 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
142 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
143
144 +++
145 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
146 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
147
148 +++
149 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
150 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
151 an interactively callable function.
152
153 +++
154 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
155 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
156 affects the initial frame.
157
158 +++
159 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
160 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
161 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
162 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
163 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
164
165 +++
166 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
167 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
168 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
169 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
170 `inhibit-splash-screen').
171
172 +++
173 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
174 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
175 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
176
177 +++
178 ** Init file changes
179 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
180 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
181
182 +++
183 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
184 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
185 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
186 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
187 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
188 \f
189 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
190
191 +++
192 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
193 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
194 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
195 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
196
197 +++
198 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
199 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
200
201 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
202 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
203
204 +++
205 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
206 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
207 the operating system or your X server.
208
209 +++
210 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
211
212 +++
213 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
214 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
215 you about it.
216
217 +++
218 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
219 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
220
221 +++
222 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
223 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
224 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
225
226 +++
227 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
228 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
229
230 +++
231 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
232
233 See below under "incremental search changes".
234
235 ---
236 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
237
238 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
239 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
240 directory with Dired.
241
242 +++
243 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
244 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
245 it remains unchanged.
246
247 +++
248 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
249 M-o M-o requests refontification.
250
251 +++
252 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
253
254 See below for more details.
255
256 +++
257 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
258 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
259 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
260 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
261 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
262 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
263 \f
264 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
265
266 +++
267 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
268 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
269
270 +++
271 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
272 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
273 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
274 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
275
276 +++
277 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
278 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
279
280 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
281 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
282
283 +++
284 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
285 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
286 the operating system or your X server.
287
288 +++
289 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
290
291 +++
292 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
293 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
294 you about it.
295
296 +++
297 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
298 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
299
300 +++
301 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
302 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
303 can be used as well.
304
305 +++
306 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
307
308 +++
309 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
310 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
311
312 ---
313 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
314 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
315
316 ---
317 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
318 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
319
320 +++
321 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
322 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
323 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
324 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
325
326 +++
327 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
328 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
329 in Indented-Text mode.
330
331 +++
332 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
333
334 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
335 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
336 in the value, use `$$'.
337
338 +++
339 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
340 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
341 `same-window'.
342
343 +++
344 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
345 from the locale.
346
347 ** Mark command changes:
348
349 +++
350 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
351 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
352 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
353
354 +++
355 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
356
357 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
358 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
359 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
360 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
361 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
362 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
363 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
364 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
365 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
366
367 +++
368 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
369
370 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
371 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
372 paragraphs.
373
374 +++
375 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
376 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
377 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
378 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
379 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
380 command only.
381
382 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
383 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
384 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
385 mark or the region.
386
387 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
388 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
389 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
390 C-g.
391
392 +++
393 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
394 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
395 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
396
397 ** Help command changes:
398
399 +++
400 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
401
402 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
403
404 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
405 that do not change:
406
407 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
408 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
409
410 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
411 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
412
413 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
414
415 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
416 run by the key sequence.
417
418 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
419 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
420 that command.
421
422 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
423 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
424
425 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
426 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
427
428 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
429 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
430
431 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
432 new-kill-line is on C-k
433
434 ---
435 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
436 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
437 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
438 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
439
440 +++
441 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
442 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
443
444 +++
445 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
446 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
447 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
448 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
449 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
450 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
451 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
452
453 +++
454 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
455 description various information about a character, including its
456 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
457 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
458 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
459
460 +++
461 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
462 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
463
464 +++
465 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
466 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
467 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
468 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
469 keyboard oriented alternative.
470
471 +++
472 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
473 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
474 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
475 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
476 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
477
478 +++
479 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
480 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
481 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
482 available.
483
484 +++
485 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
486 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
487 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
488 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
489 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
490 matching item.
491
492 ** Incremental Search changes:
493
494 +++
495 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
496 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
497 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
498 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
499 for details.
500
501 +++
502 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
503 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
504 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
505 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
506
507 +++
508 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
509 at the end of a line.
510
511 +++
512 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
513 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
514 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
515
516 +++
517 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
518 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
519 search string used as the string to replace.
520
521 +++
522 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
523 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
524 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
525
526 ** Replace command changes:
527
528 ---
529 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
530 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
531 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
532
533 +++
534 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
535 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
536 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
537 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
538 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
539 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
540 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
541 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
542 can be edited for each replacement.
543
544 +++
545 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
546 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
547
548 ---
549 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
550 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
551
552 ** File operation changes:
553
554 +++
555 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
556 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
557 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
558 is only rarely needed.
559
560 +++
561 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
562 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
563
564 +++
565 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
566 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
567
568 +++
569 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
570 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
571
572 +++
573 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
574
575 ---
576 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
577
578 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
579 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
580 directory with Dired.
581
582 +++
583 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
584 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
585 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
586 file.)
587
588 +++
589 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
590 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
591
592 +++
593 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
594 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
595 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
596 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
597 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
598 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
599
600 ---
601 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
602 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
603 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
604
605 ---
606 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
607 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
608 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
609
610 +++
611 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
612 Emacs asks for confirmation.
613
614 +++
615 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
616
617 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
618 when visiting the file.
619
620 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
621 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
622 when saving the file.
623
624 +++
625 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
626 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
627 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
628 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
629 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
630 modes do.
631
632 ** Minibuffer changes:
633
634 +++
635 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
636 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
637 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
638 prompt string.
639
640 ---
641 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
642
643 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
644 have in common and where they begin to differ.
645
646 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
647 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
648 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
649 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
650 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
651 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
652 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
653 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
654
655 +++
656 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
657 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
658 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
659 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
660 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
661 candidate is a directory.
662
663 +++
664 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
665 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
666 it remains unchanged.
667
668 +++
669 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
670 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
671 elements are deleted.
672
673 ** Redisplay changes:
674
675 +++
676 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
677 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
678 appears between the position information and the major mode.
679
680 +++
681 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
682
683 +++
684 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
685 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
686 to nil.
687
688 +++
689 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
690 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
691 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
692 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
693
694 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
695 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
696 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
697 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
698 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
699 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
700
701 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
702 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
703
704 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
705 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
706 vscroll property.
707
708 +++
709 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
710 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
711 the mode line of the currently selected window.
712
713 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
714 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
715
716 +++
717 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
718 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
719 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
720 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
721 set-fringe-style.
722
723 +++
724 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
725 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
726 the window can be scrolled.
727
728 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
729 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
730 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
731
732 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
733 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
734
735 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presense and
736 position of each bitmap individually.
737
738 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
739 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
740 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
741 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
742
743 +++
744 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
745 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
746 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
747 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
748 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
749
750 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
751 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
752
753 +++
754 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
755 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
756 outside those margins.
757
758 +++
759 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
760 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
761
762 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
763 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
764 or when the frame is resized.
765
766 ** Cursor display changes:
767
768 +++
769 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
770 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
771
772 +++
773 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
774
775 +++
776 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
777 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
778 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
779 cursor does.
780
781 +++
782 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
783 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
784 appears in.
785
786 +++
787 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
788 of the recognized cursor types.
789
790 ** Font-Lock changes:
791
792 +++
793 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
794 M-o M-o requests refontification.
795
796 +++
797 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
798 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
799 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
800
801 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
802 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
803 `Info-mode-hook'.
804
805 +++
806 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
807 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
808 The default value is 1.
809
810 +++
811 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
812 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
813 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
814 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
815 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
816
817 +++
818 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
819
820 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
821
822 *** Easy to overlook single character negation is now font-locked.
823 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
824 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
825 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
826
827 ---
828 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
829 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
830 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
831 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
832 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
833
834 ---
835 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
836
837 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
838 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
839 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
840 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
841
842 ---
843 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
844
845 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
846 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
847 refontification takes place.
848
849 ** Menu support:
850
851 ---
852 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
853 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
854 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
855 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
856 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
857 current date and time, current line and column number in the
858 mode-line.
859
860 ---
861 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
862
863 ---
864 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
865
866 ---
867 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
868 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
869 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
870
871 +++
872 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
873 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
874
875 ---
876 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
877 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
878
879 +++
880 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
881 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
882 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
883
884 ---
885 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
886 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
887
888 +++
889 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
890 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
891 the new dialog.
892
893 ** Mouse changes:
894
895 +++
896 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
897 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
898 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
899 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
900 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
901 feature is not enabled.
902
903 +++
904 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
905 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
906 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
907 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
908 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
909 to give it focus.
910
911 +++
912 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
913
914 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
915 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
916 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
917 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
918 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
919 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
920
921 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
922 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
923 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
924 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
925 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
926 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
927 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
928 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
929 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
930
931 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
932 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
933 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
934 you release it).
935
936 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
937 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
938
939 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
940 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
941
942 +++
943 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
944 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
945 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
946 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
947 also disable mouse highlighting.
948
949 +++
950 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
951 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
952 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
953
954 ---
955 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
956 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
957
958 ---
959 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
960
961 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
962 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
963 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
964 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
965
966 +++
967 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
968
969 ** Mule changes:
970
971 ---
972 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
973 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
974 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
975 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
976 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
977
978 +++
979 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
980 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
981 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
982 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
983 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
984 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
985 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
986 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
987
988 +++
989 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
990 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
991
992 +++
993 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
994 coding system.
995
996 +++
997 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
998 of a file.
999
1000 ---
1001 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1002 unicode.
1003
1004 +++
1005 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1006 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1007 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1008 command.
1009
1010 +++
1011 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1012 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1013
1014 +++
1015 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1016 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1017 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1018 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1019 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1020 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1021 mule-unicode-... ones.
1022
1023 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1024 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1025 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1026 possible.
1027
1028 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1029 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1030 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1031 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1032 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1033
1034 ---
1035 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1036 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1037 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1038 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1039
1040 ---
1041 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1042 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1043 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1044 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1045 automatically according to the locale.)
1046
1047 ---
1048 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1049 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1050 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1051 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1052 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1053 tamil-inscript.
1054
1055 ---
1056 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1057 characters.
1058
1059 ---
1060 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1061 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1062 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1063 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1064 M-f (forward-word)
1065 M-b (backward-word)
1066 M-d (kill-word)
1067 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1068 M-t (transpose-words)
1069 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1070
1071 ---
1072 *** Indian support has been updated.
1073 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1074 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1075 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1076 supported.
1077
1078 ---
1079 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1080
1081 ---
1082 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1083 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1084 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1085 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1086 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1087 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1088 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1089 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1090 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1091 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1092 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1093 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1094
1095 ---
1096 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1097 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1098 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1099
1100 ---
1101 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1102 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1103 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1104 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1105 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1106 latter is used by GNU locales.
1107
1108 ---
1109 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1110 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1111
1112 ---
1113 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1114 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1115 fontset appropriately.
1116
1117 ** Customize changes:
1118
1119 +++
1120 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1121 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1122 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1123 faces.
1124
1125 ---
1126 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1127 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1128 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1129 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1130 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1131 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1132 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1133
1134 +++
1135 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1136 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1137 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1138 under the "[State]" button.
1139
1140 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1141
1142 +++
1143 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1144 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1145 mode.
1146
1147 +++
1148 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1149 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1150 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1151
1152 ---
1153 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1154 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1155 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1156
1157 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1158 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1159 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1160 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1161 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1162
1163 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1164 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1165 t, and the status is shown.
1166
1167 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1168 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1169
1170 ** Dired mode:
1171
1172 ---
1173 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1174 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1175 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1176
1177 +++
1178 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1179 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1180
1181 +++
1182 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1183 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1184
1185 +++
1186 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1187 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1188 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1189 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1190 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1191 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1192
1193 +++
1194 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1195 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1199
1200 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1201 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1202 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1203 instead.
1204
1205 +++
1206 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1207 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1208 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1209 directory listing into a buffer.
1210
1211 ** Comint changes:
1212
1213 ---
1214 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1215 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1216 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1217 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1218 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1219
1220 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1221 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1222
1223 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1224 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1225 lines, including any prompts.
1226
1227 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1228 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1229 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1230 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1231 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1232 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1233 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1234
1235 +++
1236 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1237 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1238 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1239 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1240
1241 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1242 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1243 but declared obsolete.
1244
1245 ** M-x Compile changes:
1246
1247 ---
1248 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1249
1250 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1251 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1252 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1253 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1254
1255 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1256 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1257 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1258
1259 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1260 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1261 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1262 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1263 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1264
1265 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1266
1267 +++
1268 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1269 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1270 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1271 subprocesses inherit.
1272
1273 +++
1274 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1275 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1276 in new face `next-error'.
1277
1278 +++
1279 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1280 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1281 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1282 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1283 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1284 C-c C-f.
1285
1286 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an overlay arrow points to current
1287 message in the compilation buffer.
1288
1289 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1290 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1291 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1292 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1293 of the window.
1294
1295 ** Occur mode changes:
1296
1297 +++
1298 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1299 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1300 switching to it.
1301
1302 +++
1303 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1304 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1305
1306 +++
1307 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1308 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1309 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1310 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1311 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1312
1313 ** Grep changes:
1314
1315 +++
1316 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1317
1318 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1319 customization group.
1320
1321 ---
1322 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1323
1324 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1325 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1326
1327 +++
1328 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1329 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1330
1331 ---
1332 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1333 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1334 settings, for grep commands only.
1335
1336 +++
1337 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1338 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1339 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1340 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1341 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1342 source line is highlighted.
1343
1344 +++
1345 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1346 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1347 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1348 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1349 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1350 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1351 file.
1352
1353 +++
1354 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1355 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1356 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1357 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1358 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1359 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1360
1361 ** X Windows Support:
1362
1363 +++
1364 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1365 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1366 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1367
1368 +++
1369 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1370 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1371 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1372 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1373 Meta and Alt:
1374 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1375 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1376
1377 +++
1378 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1379 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1380
1381 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1382 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1383
1384 ---
1385 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1386 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1387 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1388 and use the more appropriately result.
1389
1390 ---
1391 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1392 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1393 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1394
1395 ** Xterm support:
1396
1397 ---
1398 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1399 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1400
1401 ---
1402 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1403 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1404 following should work:
1405 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1406 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1407 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1408
1409 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1410
1411 +++
1412 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1413 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1414 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1415 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1416 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1417 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1418 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1419 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1420 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1421
1422 ---
1423 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1424 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1425 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1426 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1427 all of these colors.
1428
1429 +++
1430 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1431 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1432 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1433 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1434 colors as on X.
1435
1436 ---
1437 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1438 \f
1439 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1440
1441 +++
1442 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1443 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1444 program files that include other program files.
1445
1446 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1447 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1448 in them.
1449
1450 +++
1451 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1452
1453 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1454 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1455 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1456 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1457
1458 ---
1459 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1460 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1461
1462 ---
1463 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1464
1465 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1466 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1467 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1468 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1469
1470 +++
1471 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1472 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1473
1474 ---
1475 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1476
1477 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1478 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1479 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1480 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1481 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1482 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1483
1484 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1485 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1486 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1487 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1488
1489 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1490 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1491 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1492 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1493 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1494 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1495 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1496
1497 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1498 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1499 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1500
1501 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1502 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1503
1504 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1505 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1506 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1507 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1508
1509 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1510 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1511 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1512 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1513
1514 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1515 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1516 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1517 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1518
1519 +++
1520 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1521 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1522 to increment the SOA serial.
1523
1524 ---
1525 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1526 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1527 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1528 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1529 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1530 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1531
1532 +++
1533 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1534 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1535
1536 +++
1537 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1538 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1539 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1540 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1541 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1542
1543 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1544 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1545 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1546 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1547 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1548 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1549
1550 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1551 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1552 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1553 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1554 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1555 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1556 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1557 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1558 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1559 or local keymaps.
1560
1561 +++
1562 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1563 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1564
1565 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1566 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1567 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1568 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1569
1570 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1571 defined macros.
1572
1573 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1574 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1575 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1576 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1577 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1578 for more commands.
1579
1580 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1581 the keyboard macro ring.
1582
1583 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1584 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1585
1586 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1587 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1588 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1589 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1590
1591 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1592 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1593 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1594
1595 ---
1596 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1597 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1598 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1599
1600 +++
1601 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1602 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1603
1604 +++
1605 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1606 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1607 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1608 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1609 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1610 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1611 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1612 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1613 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1614
1615 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1616
1617 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1618 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1619 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1620 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1621 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1622 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1623
1624 ---
1625 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1626 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1627 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1628 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1629
1630 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1631
1632 ---
1633 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1634 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1635 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1636 settings.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1640 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1641 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1642 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1643
1644 +++
1645 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1646 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1647
1648 +++
1649 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1650 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1651 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1652 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1653 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1654 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1655
1656 +++
1657 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1658 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1659
1660 +++
1661 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1662
1663 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1664 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1665 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1666 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1667 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1668 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1669 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1670 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1671 `rsync' to do the copying).
1672
1673 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1674 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1675
1676 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1677
1678 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1679
1680 ---
1681 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1682
1683 ---
1684 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1685 configuration files.
1686
1687 +++
1688 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1689 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1690 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1691 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1692 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1693 recognized.
1694
1695 ---
1696 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1697
1698 +++
1699 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1700
1701 ---
1702 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1703 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1704 \f
1705 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1706
1707 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1708
1709 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1710 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1711 faces.
1712
1713 +++
1714 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1715 of the file that precede the first header line.
1716
1717 +++
1718 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1719
1720 ---
1721 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1722 run most curses applications now.
1723
1724 +++
1725 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1726
1727 +++
1728 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1729 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1730 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1731
1732 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1733 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1734 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1735
1736 ---
1737 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1738 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1739
1740 ---
1741 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1742 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1743 incompatible change.
1744
1745 ---
1746 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1747
1748 +++
1749 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1750 resync points in both windows.
1751
1752 +++
1753 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1754
1755 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1756 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1760 when Emacs visits them.
1761
1762 ** Info mode changes:
1763
1764 +++
1765 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1766 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1767
1768 ---
1769 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1770
1771 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1772 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1773 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1774 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1775 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1776 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1777 Info node.
1778
1779 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1780 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1781 search without prompting for a new search string.
1782
1783 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1784 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1785 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1786
1787 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1788
1789 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1790 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1791
1792 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1793 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1794 possible matches.
1795
1796 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1797 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1798 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1799
1800 ---
1801 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1802 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1803
1804 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1805 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1806
1807 +++
1808 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1809
1810 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1811 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1812
1813 ---
1814 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1815
1816 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1817 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1818 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1819
1820 +++
1821 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1822
1823 ---
1824 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1825
1826 ** Lisp mode changes:
1827
1828 ---
1829 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1830
1831 +++
1832 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1833
1834 *** New features in evaluation commands
1835
1836 +++
1837 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1838 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1839
1840 +++
1841 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1842 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1843 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1844 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1845 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1846
1847 +++
1848 ** CC mode changes.
1849
1850 *** Font lock support.
1851 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1852 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1853 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1854 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1855 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1856 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1857
1858 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1859 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1860 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1861 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1862 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1863 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1864 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1865 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1866 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1867
1868 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1869 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1870 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1871 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1872 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1873 take the better part of a minute.
1874
1875 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1876 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1877 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1878 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1879 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1880 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1881
1882 **** Support for documentation comments.
1883 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1884 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1885 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1886 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1887
1888 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1889 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1890 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1891 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1892
1893 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1894 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1895 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1896 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1897 parens.
1898
1899 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1900 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1901 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1902 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1903 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1904
1905 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1906 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1907 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1908 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1909 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1910
1911 *** Support for the AWK language.
1912 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1913 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1914 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1915 Here is a summary:
1916
1917 **** Indentation Engine
1918 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1919
1920 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1921 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1922 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1923 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1924 definition, or structured statement.
1925
1926 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1927 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1928 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1929
1930 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1931 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1932 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1933 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1934
1935 **** Font Locking
1936 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1937 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1938 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1939 the AWK language itself.
1940
1941 **** Comment Commands
1942 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1943 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1944
1945 **** Movement Commands
1946 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1947 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1948 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1949
1950 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1951 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1952 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1953 functions.
1954
1955 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1956 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1957 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1958 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1959
1960 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1961 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1962 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1963 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1964 composition-close, and incomposition.
1965
1966 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1967 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
1968 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1969
1970 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
1971
1972 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
1973 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
1974 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
1975 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
1976
1977 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
1978 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
1979
1980 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1981
1982 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
1983 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
1984 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1985 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1986
1987 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1988
1989 is now analysed as
1990
1991 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1992
1993 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1994 symbol.
1995
1996 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
1997 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
1998 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1999 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2000
2001 *** API changes for derived modes.
2002
2003 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2004 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2005 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2006 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2007 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2008
2009 **** New language variable system.
2010 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2011
2012 **** New initialization functions.
2013 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2014 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2015 `c-init-language-vars'.
2016
2017 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2018 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2019 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2020 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2021
2022 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2023 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2024 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2025 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2026 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2027
2028 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2029 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2030 its substatement. E.g:
2031
2032 if (x)
2033 x_is_true:
2034 do_stuff();
2035
2036 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2037
2038 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2039 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2040 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2041 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2042 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2043 inside `#define's.
2044
2045 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2046
2047 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2048 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2049 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2050 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2051 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2052 empty lines within the macro better.
2053
2054 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2055 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2056 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2057
2058 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2059 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2060 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2061 backslashes can be moved.
2062
2063 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2064 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2065 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2066 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2067 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2068
2069 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2070 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2071 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2072 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2073 backslash) in the macro.
2074
2075 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2076 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2077 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2078 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2079 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2080 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2081
2082 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2083 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2084
2085 *** New lineup functions
2086
2087 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2088 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2089 continues. E.g:
2090
2091 result = prefix + "A message "
2092 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2093
2094 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2095 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2096
2097 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2098 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2099 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2100
2101 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2102 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2103
2104 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2105 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2106
2107 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2108 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2109 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2110 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2111 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2112 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2113
2114 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2115 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2116 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2117 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2118 context.
2119
2120 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2121 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2122 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2123 happen when macros are involved.
2124
2125 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2126 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2127 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2128 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2129 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2130 line is left untouched.
2131
2132 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2133 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2134 syntactic indentation.
2135
2136 ---
2137 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2138
2139 ---
2140 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2141 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2142 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2143 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2144
2145 ** Fortran mode changes:
2146
2147 ---
2148 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2149 highlighting for the old default.
2150
2151 +++
2152 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2153 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2154 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2155
2156 +++
2157 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2158 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2159 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2160 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2161
2162 ---
2163 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2164 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2165 majority.
2166
2167 ---
2168 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2169 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2170
2171 ---
2172 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2173 to support use of font-lock.
2174
2175 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2176
2177 ---
2178 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2179 automatically.
2180
2181 +++
2182 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2183 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2184 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2185 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2186 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2187 from the file name or buffer contents.
2188
2189 +++
2190 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2191
2192 ** TeX modes:
2193
2194 +++
2195 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2196
2197 +++
2198 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2199 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2200 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2201 TeX commands to use at startup.
2202
2203 ---
2204 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2205 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2206
2207 +++
2208 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2209
2210 ** BibTeX mode:
2211
2212 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2213 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2214
2215 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2216 an existing BibTeX entry.
2217
2218 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2219
2220 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2221 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2222 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2223 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2224 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2225 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2226
2227 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2228 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2229
2230 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2231 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2232
2233 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2234 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2235
2236 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2237 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2238
2239 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2240 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2241 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2242
2243 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2244 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2245
2246 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2247 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2248
2249 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2250 in multiple BibTeX files.
2251
2252 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2253 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2254
2255 +++
2256 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2257 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2258 and `C-c C-r'.
2259
2260 ** GUD changes:
2261
2262 +++
2263 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2264 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2265
2266 ---
2267 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2268 and other common debugger commands.
2269
2270 +++
2271 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2272 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2273 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2274 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2275 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2276 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2277 breakpoints.
2278
2279 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2280
2281 *** GUD tooltips can be toggled independently of normal tooltips
2282 with the minor mode `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2283
2284 +++
2285 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2286 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2287 not executing.
2288
2289 ---
2290 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2291
2292 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2293 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2294 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2295 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2296 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2297
2298 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2299 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2300 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2301 (gud-finish).
2302
2303 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2304 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2305
2306 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2307 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2308 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2309
2310 Added Customization Variables
2311
2312 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2313
2314 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2315 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2316 java sources (previous method).
2317
2318 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2319 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2320 is nil).
2321
2322 Minor Improvements
2323
2324 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2325 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2326 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2327 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2328 `starttls' tool).
2329
2330 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2331
2332 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2333
2334 +++
2335 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2336
2337 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2338 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2339 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2340 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2341 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2342 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2343 be mode dependent.
2344
2345 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2346 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2347 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2348 toggles this mode.
2349
2350 +++
2351 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2352 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2353 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2354 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2355 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2356 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2357 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2358 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2359 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2360
2361 +++
2362 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2363 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2364 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2365 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2366 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2367
2368 ---
2369 ** recentf changes.
2370
2371 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2372 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2373 automatic cleanup.
2374
2375 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2376 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2377 keep in the recent list.
2378
2379 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2380 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2381 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2382 recent list with different symbolic links.
2383
2384 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2385 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2386 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2387
2388 +++
2389 ** Desktop package
2390
2391 +++
2392 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2393
2394 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2395
2396 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2397
2398 ---
2399 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2400 buffer list.
2401
2402 +++
2403 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2404 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2405 idle).
2406
2407 +++
2408 *** New commands:
2409 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2410 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2411 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2412 it was loaded.
2413 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2414 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2415
2416 ---
2417 *** New customizable variables:
2418 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2419 killed.
2420 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2421 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2422 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2423 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2424 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2425 should not delete.
2426 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2427 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2428 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2429 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2430
2431 +++
2432 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2433
2434 ---
2435 *** New hooks:
2436 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2437 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2438
2439 ---
2440 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2441
2442 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2443 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2444 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2445 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2446 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2447 feature.
2448
2449 ** EDiff changes.
2450
2451 +++
2452 *** When comparing directories.
2453 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2454 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2455 from one directory to another.
2456
2457 +++
2458 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2459 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2460 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2461 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2462 comparison.
2463
2464 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2465 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2466 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2467
2468 +++
2469 ** Etags changes.
2470
2471 *** New regular expressions features
2472
2473 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2474
2475 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2476 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2477 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2478 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2479 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2480 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2481 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2482 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2483 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2484 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2485
2486 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2487
2488 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2489 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2490 CR, TAB, VT,
2491
2492 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2493
2494 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2495 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2496 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2497
2498 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2499
2500 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2501 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2502
2503 *** New language parsing features
2504
2505 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2506
2507 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2508
2509 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2510
2511 **** New language HTML.
2512
2513 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2514 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2515
2516 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2517
2518 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2519 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2520
2521 **** New language Lua.
2522
2523 All functions are tagged.
2524
2525 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2526
2527 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2528 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2529 package::sub.
2530
2531 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2532
2533 **** New language PHP.
2534
2535 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2536 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2537
2538 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2539
2540 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2541 renewenvironment.
2542
2543 *** Honour #line directives.
2544
2545 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2546 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2547 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2548 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2549 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2550
2551 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2552
2553 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2554 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2555 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2556 the file FILE.
2557
2558 ** VC Changes
2559
2560 +++
2561 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2562 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2563
2564 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2565 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2566 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2567 `.emacs' file:
2568
2569 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2570
2571 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2572
2573 +++
2574 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2575 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2576
2577 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2578 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2579 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2580
2581 +++
2582 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2583
2584 +++
2585 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2586
2587 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2588 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2589 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2590
2591 P: annotates the previous revision
2592 N: annotates the next revision
2593 J: annotates the revision at line
2594 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2595 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2596 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2597 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2598
2599 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2600
2601 +++
2602 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2603 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2604 in the repository.
2605
2606 +++
2607 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2608 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2609 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2610 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2611
2612 +++
2613 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2614 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2615 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2616
2617 +++
2618 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2619
2620 See the documentation of the user option
2621 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2622
2623 ** Rmail changes:
2624
2625 ---
2626 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2627
2628 +++
2629 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2630
2631 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2632 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2633 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2634 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2635 used instead of the native one.
2636
2637 ** Gnus package
2638
2639 ---
2640 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2641
2642 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2643 PGP/MIME.
2644
2645 ---
2646 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2647
2648 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2649
2650 ---
2651 ** MH-E changes.
2652
2653 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2654 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2655
2656 ** Calendar changes:
2657
2658 +++
2659 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2660 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2661
2662 +++
2663 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2664 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2665 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2666 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2667 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2668 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2669 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2670 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2671 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2672
2673 +++
2674 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2675 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2676 count backward from the end of the year.
2677
2678 +++
2679 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2680 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2681 day of that ISO week.
2682
2683 ---
2684 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2685 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2686
2687 ---
2688 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2689 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2690 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2691 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2692
2693 ---
2694 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2695 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2696 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2697
2698 +++
2699 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2700 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2701 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2702 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2703
2704 +++
2705 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2706 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2707 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2708 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2709 formats.
2710
2711 ---
2712 ** sql changes.
2713
2714 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2715 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2716 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2717 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2718 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2719
2720 The following values are supported:
2721
2722 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2723 db2 DB2
2724 informix Informix
2725 ingres Ingres
2726 interbase Interbase
2727 linter Linter
2728 ms Microsoft
2729 mysql MySQL
2730 oracle Oracle
2731 postgres Postgres
2732 solid Solid
2733 sqlite SQLite
2734 sybase Sybase
2735
2736 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2737 SQL mode indicator.
2738
2739 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2740 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2741 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2742
2743 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2744
2745 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2746 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2747 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2748 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2749
2750 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2751 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2752
2753 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2754
2755 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2756 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2757
2758 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2759
2760 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2761 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2762 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2763 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2764 terminated.
2765
2766 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2767 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2768 credentials to authenticate the user.
2769
2770 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2771 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2772 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2773
2774 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2775 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2776
2777 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2778 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2779 defaults.
2780
2781 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2782 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2783 `sql-product'.
2784
2785 ---
2786 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2787
2788 ** FFAP changes:
2789
2790 +++
2791 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2792
2793 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2794 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2795 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2796 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2797
2798 ---
2799 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2800
2801 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2802 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2803
2804 ---
2805 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2806
2807 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2808 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2809 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2810 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2811 with other details of skeleton construction.
2812
2813 ---
2814 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2815 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2816 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2817 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2818
2819 +++
2820 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2821 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2822 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2823
2824 ---
2825 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2826
2827 ---
2828 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2829 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2830 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2831 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2832
2833 ---
2834 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2835
2836 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2837 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2838 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2839
2840 ---
2841 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2842 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2843 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2844 using strokes as an input method.
2845
2846 ** Emacs server changes:
2847
2848 +++
2849 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2850
2851 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2852 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2853 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2854 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2855
2856 +++
2857 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2858 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2859 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2860
2861 +++
2862 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2863
2864 ---
2865 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2866
2867 +++
2868 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2869
2870 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2871 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2872 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2873
2874 ---
2875 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2876 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2877
2878 ---
2879 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2880
2881 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
2882 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
2883 inverse-video.
2884
2885 ---
2886 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2887
2888 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2889 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2890 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2891
2892 ---
2893 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
2894
2895 ---
2896 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
2897
2898 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
2899 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
2900 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
2901 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
2902
2903 ---
2904 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
2905
2906 ---
2907 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
2908
2909 ---
2910 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
2911 \f
2912 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
2913
2914 +++
2915 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2916
2917 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2918 existing values. For example:
2919
2920 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
2921
2922 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2923 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
2924
2925 ---
2926 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2927
2928 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2929 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2930
2931 ---
2932 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2933
2934 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2935
2936 ---
2937 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2938
2939 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2940 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2941 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2942 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2943 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2944 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2945
2946 ---
2947 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2948
2949 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2950 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2951 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2952 sound support for those formats.
2953
2954 ---
2955 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2956
2957 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2958
2959 ---
2960 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2961
2962 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2963 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2964 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2965
2966 ---
2967 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2968
2969 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2970 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2971 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2972 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2973 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2974 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2975 you wish to use them in other faces.
2976
2977 ---
2978 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2979
2980 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2981 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2982 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2983 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2984 any customizations.
2985
2986 ---
2987 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
2988
2989 ---
2990 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2991 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2992 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2993 \f
2994 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2995
2996 +++
2997 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
2998 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
2999 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3000 `undefined'.)
3001
3002 +++
3003 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3004 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3005 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3006
3007 ---
3008 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3009 \f
3010 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3011
3012 ** General Lisp changes:
3013
3014 +++
3015 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3016
3017 +++
3018 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3019
3020 +++
3021 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3022
3023 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3024 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3025 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3026
3027 +++
3028 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3029
3030 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3031
3032 +++
3033 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3034
3035 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3036 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3037 first one.
3038
3039 +++
3040 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3041
3042 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3043 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3044
3045 +++
3046 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3047
3048 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3049 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3050 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3051 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3052
3053 +++
3054 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3055
3056 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3057
3058 +++
3059 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3060
3061 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3062 longer accepted.
3063
3064 +++
3065 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3066
3067 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3068 cyclic.
3069
3070 +++
3071 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3072
3073 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3074 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3075
3076 +++
3077 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3078
3079 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3080 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3081 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3082
3083 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3084 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3085
3086 +++
3087 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3088
3089 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3090 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3091 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3092
3093 +++
3094 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3095
3096 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3097 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3098 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3099
3100 +++
3101 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3102
3103 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3104 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3105 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3106 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3107
3108 +++
3109 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3110
3111 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3112 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3113 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3114
3115 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3116 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3117
3118 +++
3119 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3120
3121 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3122
3123 +++
3124 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3125
3126 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3127 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3128 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3129
3130 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3131
3132 +++
3133 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3134
3135 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3136 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3137
3138 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3139
3140 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3141 possible declaration specifiers are:
3142
3143 (indent INDENT)
3144 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3145
3146 (edebug DEBUG)
3147 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3148 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3149 but this is cleaner.)
3150
3151 ---
3152 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3153
3154 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3155
3156 ---
3157 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3158
3159 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3160 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3161 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3162 forms.
3163
3164 +++
3165 ** Variable aliases:
3166
3167 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3168
3169 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3170 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3171 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3172 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3173
3174 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3175 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3176
3177 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3178
3179 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3180 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3181 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3182
3183 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3184 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3185
3186 +++
3187 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3188 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3189
3190 ** defcustom changes:
3191
3192 +++
3193 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3194
3195 ** String changes:
3196
3197 +++
3198 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3199
3200 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3201 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3202 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3203
3204 +++
3205 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3206
3207 +++
3208 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3209
3210 +++
3211 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3212 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3213 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3214 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3215 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3216
3217 +++
3218 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3219 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3220
3221 +++
3222 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3223 text properties.
3224
3225 +++
3226 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3227 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3228 been declared obsolete.
3229
3230 +++
3231 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3232
3233 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3234 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3235 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3236 warnings in a separate window.
3237
3238 +++
3239 ** Progress reporters.
3240
3241 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3242 progress messages for the user.
3243
3244 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3245 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3246 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3247
3248 ** Buffer positions:
3249
3250 +++
3251 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3252 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3253 the usable window height and width is used.
3254
3255 +++
3256 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3257 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3258 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3259 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3260 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3261
3262 +++
3263 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3264
3265 It defaults to 1.
3266
3267 +++
3268 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3269
3270 It defaults to 1.
3271
3272 +++
3273 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3274
3275 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3276 functionality.
3277
3278 +++
3279 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3280
3281 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3282
3283 +++
3284 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3285
3286 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3287 give up and return LIMIT.
3288
3289 +++
3290 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3291 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3292 arg is non-nil.
3293
3294 +++
3295 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3296 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3297 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3298
3299 ** Text modification:
3300
3301 +++
3302 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3303 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3304 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3305
3306 +++
3307 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3308 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3309 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3310
3311 +++
3312 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3313 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3314 inserted substring.
3315
3316 +++
3317 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3318 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3319 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3320 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3321 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3322
3323 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3324 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3325 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3326 text.
3327
3328 +++
3329 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3330 argument.
3331
3332 +++
3333 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3334 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3335 be inserted is translated through it.
3336
3337 ---
3338 *** Text clones.
3339
3340 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3341 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3342 clone to the other.
3343
3344 ---
3345 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3346
3347 +++
3348 ** Atomic change groups.
3349
3350 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3351 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3352 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3353
3354 (atomic-change-group
3355 (insert foo)
3356 (delete-region x y))
3357
3358 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3359 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3360 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3361 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3362
3363 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3364 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3365
3366 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3367 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3368 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3369 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3370
3371 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3372 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3373 do this.
3374
3375 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3376 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3377 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3378 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3379
3380 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3381 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3382 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3383 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3384 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3385 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3386 twice.
3387
3388 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3389 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3390 returned values, like this:
3391
3392 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3393 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3394
3395 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3396 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3397 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3398
3399 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3400 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3401 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3402 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3403 finished.
3404
3405 ** Buffer-related changes:
3406
3407 ---
3408 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3409
3410 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3411
3412 +++
3413 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3414
3415 +++
3416 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3417 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3418 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3419 value of VARIABLE instead.
3420
3421 ** Local variables lists:
3422
3423 +++
3424 *** Text properties in local variables.
3425
3426 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3427 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3428
3429 +++
3430 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3431 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3432 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3433 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3434 needed.
3435
3436 ---
3437 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3438 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3439 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3440 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3441 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3442 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3443
3444 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3445 confirmation as before.
3446
3447 ** Searching and matching changes:
3448
3449 +++
3450 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3451 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3452 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3453
3454 +++
3455 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3456 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3457 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3458 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3459
3460 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3461 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3462
3463 +++
3464 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3465
3466 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3467 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3468 specified by the syntax table.
3469
3470 ---
3471 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3472
3473 +++
3474 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3475 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3476 characters and ranges.
3477
3478 ---
3479 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3480 properties from surrounding text.
3481
3482 +++
3483 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3484 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3485 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3486
3487 +++
3488 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3489 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3490 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3491
3492 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3493 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3494 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3495 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3496 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3497
3498 ** Undo changes:
3499
3500 +++
3501 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3502
3503 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3504 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3505 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3506
3507 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3508 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3509 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3510
3511 +++
3512 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3513 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3514 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3515
3516 +++
3517 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3518 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3519
3520 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3521 elements with the following format:
3522 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3523
3524 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3525 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3526 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3527 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3528
3529 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3530 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3531 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3532 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3533 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3534 rectangle.
3535 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3536 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3537 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3538 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3539 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3540 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3541 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3542 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3543
3544 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3545 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3546 the killed text.
3547
3548 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3549 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3550 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3551 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3552 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3553
3554 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3555 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3556 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3557 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3558
3559 ** Syntax table changes:
3560
3561 +++
3562 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3563
3564 +++
3565 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3566 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3567 of text properties as well as the character code.
3568
3569 +++
3570 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3571 by `syntax-after').
3572
3573 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3574 current syntactic context at point.
3575
3576 ** File operation changes:
3577
3578 +++
3579 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3580 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3581
3582 +++
3583 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3584 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3585 operation.
3586
3587 +++
3588 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3589 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3590 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3591 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3592
3593 +++
3594 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3595 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3596
3597 +++
3598 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3599 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3600 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3601
3602 +++
3603 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3604
3605 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3606
3607 +++
3608 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3609 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3610
3611 +++
3612 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3613 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3614 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3615 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3616
3617 +++
3618 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3619 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3620 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3621 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3622
3623 +++
3624 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3625 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3626 it's modified).
3627
3628 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3629 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3630 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3631 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3632 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3633 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3634 further filter candidate files.
3635
3636 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3637 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3638 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3639
3640 ---
3641 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3642
3643 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3644 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3645 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3646 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3647 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3648
3649 +++
3650 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3651
3652 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3653 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3654 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3655 operations.
3656
3657 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3658 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3659
3660 ** Input changes:
3661
3662 +++
3663 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3664 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3665 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3666
3667 +++
3668 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3669 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3670 it returns just the directory name.
3671
3672 ---
3673 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3674 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3675 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3676
3677 +++
3678 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3679 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3680 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3681 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3682
3683 ** Minibuffer changes:
3684
3685 +++
3686 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3687 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3688 defaults to the current buffer.
3689
3690 +++
3691 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3692 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3693
3694 +++
3695 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3696 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3697
3698 +++
3699 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3700 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3701 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3702 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3703 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3704
3705 ---
3706 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3707 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3708
3709 +++
3710 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3711 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3712 `read-file-name' function.
3713
3714 +++
3715 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3716
3717 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3718 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3719
3720 ** Completion changes:
3721
3722 +++
3723 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3724 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3725 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3726 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3727 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3728
3729 +++
3730 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3731 as a dynamic completion table.
3732
3733 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3734
3735 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3736 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3737 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3738 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3739 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3740 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3741
3742 +++
3743 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3744 as a lazy completion table.
3745
3746 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3747
3748 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3749 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3750 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3751 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3752 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3753 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3754
3755 +++
3756 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3757
3758 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3759
3760 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3761 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3762 example,
3763
3764 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3765
3766 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3767
3768 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3769 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3770 binding and lookup functionality.
3771
3772 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3773 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3774 original command.
3775
3776 Example:
3777 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3778 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3779 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3780 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3781 `kill-word'.
3782
3783 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3784 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3785 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3786
3787 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3788 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3789
3790 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3791 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3792
3793 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3794 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3795 runs `my-kill-line'.
3796
3797 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3798
3799 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3800 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3801 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3802 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3803
3804 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3805 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3806
3807 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3808 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3809
3810 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3811 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3812 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3813 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3814 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3815 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3816
3817 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3818 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3819 command was not remapped.
3820
3821 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3822 over minor mode keymaps.
3823
3824 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3825 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3826 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3827
3828 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3829
3830 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3831 bindings of the parent keymap.
3832
3833 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3834
3835 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3836 active keymaps.
3837
3838 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3839 defined keys and their definitions.
3840
3841 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3842
3843 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3844 in the keymap.
3845
3846 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3847
3848 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3849 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
3850 keymap alist to this list.
3851
3852 ** Abbrev changes:
3853
3854 +++
3855 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
3856
3857 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3858
3859 +++
3860 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
3861
3862 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
3863 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
3864 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
3865 specify this flag.
3866
3867 +++
3868 ** Enhancements to process support
3869
3870 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3871 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
3872
3873 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
3874
3875 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
3876 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
3877 functions.
3878
3879 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
3880 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3881
3882 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3883 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3884
3885 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
3886 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
3887 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
3888 entire property list of a process.
3889
3890 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
3891 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3892 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3893 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3894 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3895 speech synthesis.
3896
3897 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3898
3899 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3900 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3901 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3902 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
3903 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3904 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3905 emacs tries to read it.
3906
3907 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
3908
3909 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
3910 process.
3911
3912 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3913 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
3914 `default-directory'.
3915
3916 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
3917 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
3918
3919 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
3920 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
3921 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3922
3923 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3924 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3925
3926 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
3927 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3928
3929 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
3930 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3931 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3932 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3933 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3934
3935 +++
3936 ** Enhanced networking support.
3937
3938 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
3939 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3940 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3941
3942 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3943 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3944 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3945 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3946 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3947 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3948 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3949 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3950
3951 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3952 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3953
3954 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
3955
3956 *** New function `open-network-stream-nowait'.
3957
3958 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3959 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3960 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3961 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3962 matching "open" or "failed".
3963
3964 *** New function `open-network-stream-server'.
3965
3966 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3967 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3968 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3969 is called for the new process.
3970
3971 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
3972
3973 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3974 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3975
3976 *** New function `format-network-address'.
3977
3978 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
3979 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3980 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3981 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3982 string for other formatting options.
3983
3984 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
3985
3986 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
3987 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
3988 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
3989
3990 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
3991 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
3992
3993 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
3994
3995 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
3996 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
3997 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
3998 stopped state.
3999
4000 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4001
4002 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4003 current network addresses.
4004
4005 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4006
4007 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4008 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4009
4010 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4011
4012 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4013 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4014 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4015 "connection broken by remote peer".
4016
4017 ** Using window objects:
4018
4019 +++
4020 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4021
4022 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4023 header line.
4024
4025 +++
4026 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4027
4028 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4029 or the header line.
4030
4031 +++
4032 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4033
4034 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4035 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4036 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4037 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4038 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4039
4040 +++
4041 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4042 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4043 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4044 the mode line.
4045
4046 +++
4047 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4048 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4049
4050 +++
4051 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4052 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4053
4054 +++
4055 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4056
4057 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4058
4059 +++
4060 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4061 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4062 by calling `select-window'.
4063
4064 +++
4065 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4066
4067 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4068 and scroll-bar settings.
4069
4070 +++
4071 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4072
4073 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4074 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4075
4076 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4077 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4078
4079 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4080 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4081
4082 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4083 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4084 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4085 foreground color of the bitmap.
4086
4087 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4088 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4089 bitmap of the display line.
4090
4091 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4092 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4093 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4094 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4095 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4096
4097 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4098 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4099
4100 ** Other window fringe features:
4101
4102 +++
4103 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4104
4105 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4106 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4107 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4108 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4109
4110 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4111 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4112 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4113 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4114 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4115 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4116
4117 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4118 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4119 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4120 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4121
4122 +++
4123 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4124
4125 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4126 position settings.
4127
4128 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4129 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4130 `set-window-fringes'.
4131
4132 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4133 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4134 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4135 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4136
4137 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4138 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4139 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4140 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4141 an update of the display margins.
4142
4143 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4144 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4145
4146 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4147 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4148 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4149 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4150 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4151 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4152 of the display margins.
4153
4154 ** Redisplay features:
4155
4156 +++
4157 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4158
4159 +++
4160 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4161 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4162 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4163 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4164 forcing an explicit window update.
4165
4166 +++
4167 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4168 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4169 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4170
4171 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4172 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4173
4174 +++
4175 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4176 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4177
4178 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4179 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4180
4181 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4182 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4183 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4184 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4185 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4186 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4187
4188 +++
4189 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4190
4191 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4192 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4193
4194 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4195 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4196 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4197 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4198 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4199
4200 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4201 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4202 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4203
4204 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4205 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4206 the given value.
4207
4208 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4209 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4210 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4211
4212 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4213 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4214
4215 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4216 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4217 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4218 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4219 exactly that many pixels high.
4220
4221 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4222 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4223 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4224 the `line-spacing' variable.
4225
4226 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4227 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4228
4229 +++
4230 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4231 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4232
4233 +++
4234 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4235
4236 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4237 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4238 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4239
4240 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4241 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4242 are supported:
4243
4244 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4245 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4246 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4247 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4248 | scroll-bar | text
4249 POS ::= left | center | right
4250 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4251 OP ::= + | -
4252
4253 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4254 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4255 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4256 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4257 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4258 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4259 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4260 the image.
4261
4262 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4263 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4264 corresponding area of the window.
4265
4266 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4267 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4268 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4269 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4270 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4271 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4272 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4273 the width of the area.
4274
4275 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4276 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4277
4278 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4279 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4280 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4281
4282 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4283 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4284 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4285 height) of the specified image.
4286
4287 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4288 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4289
4290 +++
4291 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4292 text property string that may be present at the current window
4293 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4294 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4295
4296 +++
4297 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4298 supported on text terminals.
4299
4300 +++
4301 *** Support for displaying image slices
4302
4303 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4304 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4305
4306 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4307 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4308
4309 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4310 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4311
4312 +++
4313 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4314
4315 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4316 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4317 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4318 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4319 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4320 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4321 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4322 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4323
4324 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4325 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4326 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4327 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4328 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4329 for possible pointer shapes.
4330
4331 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4332 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4333 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4334
4335 ** Mouse pointer features:
4336
4337 +++ (lispref)
4338 ??? (man)
4339 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4340 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4341 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4342 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4343 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4344
4345 +++
4346 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4347 :pointer image property.
4348
4349 +++
4350 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4351 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4352
4353 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4354
4355 +++
4356 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4357 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4358
4359 +++
4360 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4361 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4362 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4363
4364 +++
4365 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4366
4367 +++
4368 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4369
4370 +++
4371 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4372 text area).
4373
4374 +++
4375 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4376 and all areas.
4377
4378 +++
4379 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4380 of the mouse event position.
4381
4382 +++
4383 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4384
4385 +++
4386 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4387 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4388
4389 +++
4390 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4391 (image or character) clicked on.
4392
4393 +++
4394 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4395
4396 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4397 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4398 the total width and height of that object.
4399
4400 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4401
4402 +++
4403 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4404 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4405
4406 +++
4407 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4408
4409 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4410 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4411 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4412 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4413
4414 +++
4415 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4416 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4417 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4418 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4419 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4420
4421 +++
4422 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4423
4424 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4425 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4426
4427 ** Face changes
4428
4429 +++
4430 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4431 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4432 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4433 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4434 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4435 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4436
4437 +++
4438 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4439 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4440
4441 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4442 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4443 defined with `defface'.
4444
4445 ---
4446 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4447 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4448 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4449 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4450 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4451
4452 +++
4453 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4454 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4455 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4456 by them).
4457
4458 +++
4459 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4460 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4461 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4462 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4463 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4464
4465 ---
4466 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4467 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4468 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4469
4470 +++
4471 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4472
4473 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4474 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4475 attribute.
4476
4477 +++
4478 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4479 help with handling relative face attributes.
4480
4481 +++
4482 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4483
4484 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4485 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4486 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4487 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4488 `face' properties.
4489
4490 ---
4491 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4492 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4493
4494 ** Font-Lock changes:
4495
4496 +++
4497 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4498
4499 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4500 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4501 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4502 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4503
4504 +++
4505 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4506
4507 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4508 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4509 properties than `face'.
4510
4511 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4512 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4513
4514 ---
4515 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4516
4517 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4518 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4519 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4520 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4521 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4522
4523 s{
4524 foo
4525 }{
4526 bar
4527 }e
4528
4529 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4530 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4531 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4532 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4533
4534 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4535
4536 +++
4537 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4538 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4539 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4540 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4541
4542 +++
4543 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4544
4545 +++
4546 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4547 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4548 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4549
4550 ---
4551 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4552 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4553 it in that buffer.
4554
4555 +++
4556 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4557 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4558 the language.
4559
4560 +++
4561 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4562 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4563
4564 +++
4565 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4566 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4567 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4568
4569 ** Minor mode changes:
4570
4571 +++
4572 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4573 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4574
4575 +++
4576 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4577
4578 +++
4579 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4580
4581 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4582 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4583
4584 ** Command loop changes:
4585
4586 +++
4587 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4588 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4589 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4590
4591 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4592 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4593
4594 +++
4595 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4596
4597 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4598 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4599 macros.
4600
4601 +++
4602 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4603 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4604 covered by an image or composition property.
4605
4606 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4607 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4608 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4609 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4610 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4611
4612 +++
4613 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4614 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4615 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4616 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4617 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4618
4619 +++
4620 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4621 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4622 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4623
4624 +++
4625 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4626 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4627
4628 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4629
4630 +++
4631 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4632 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4633 current file redefined it).
4634
4635 +++
4636 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4637 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4638
4639 +++
4640 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4641 variable or face definitions.
4642
4643 +++
4644 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4645 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4646 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4647
4648 ---
4649 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4650 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4651 than 3 levels of nesting.
4652
4653 +++
4654 ** Byte compiler changes:
4655
4656 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4657 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4658 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4659 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4660 compilation output buffer.
4661
4662 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4663 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4664
4665 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4666 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4667 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4668 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4669 forms:
4670
4671 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4672 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4673
4674 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4675 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4676 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4677 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4678 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4679 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4680
4681 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4682 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4683 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4684 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4685 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4686 you anything.
4687
4688 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4689
4690 ---
4691 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4692 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4693 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4694
4695 ** Frame operations:
4696
4697 +++
4698 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4699
4700 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4701 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4702
4703 +++
4704 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4705 for all (existing and future) frames.
4706
4707 +++
4708 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4709 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4710 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4711 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4712
4713 +++
4714 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4715 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4716
4717 ** Mule changes:
4718
4719 +++
4720 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4721
4722 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4723 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4724 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4725 now:
4726
4727 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4728
4729 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4730 the time it takes to convert the format.
4731
4732 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4733 wasteful.
4734
4735 ---
4736 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4737 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4738
4739 +++
4740 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4741 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4742 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4743 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4744
4745 ---
4746 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4747 of one coding system from another coding system.
4748
4749 ---
4750 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4751 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4752 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4753
4754 +++
4755 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4756 it is read from a file without decoding.
4757
4758 ---
4759 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4760 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4761
4762 ---
4763 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4764 current input method to input a character.
4765
4766 ** Mode line changes:
4767
4768 +++
4769 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4770
4771 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4772 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4773
4774 +++
4775 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4776 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4777
4778 +++
4779 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4780 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4781 line.
4782
4783 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4784
4785 ---
4786 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4787 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4788 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4789 several versions ago.
4790
4791 ---
4792 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4793 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4794 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4795
4796 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4797 made with easy-menu.
4798
4799 ---
4800 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4801 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4802 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4803 need to have a name.
4804
4805 ** Operating system access:
4806
4807 +++
4808 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4809 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4810
4811 +++
4812 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4813 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4814 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4815
4816 +++
4817 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4818
4819 ---
4820 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4821 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4822 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4823
4824 ---
4825 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4826 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4827
4828 ** Miscellaneous:
4829
4830 +++
4831 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4832
4833 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4834 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4835 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4836 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4837 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4838 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4839 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4840
4841 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4842
4843 +++
4844 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4845
4846 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4847
4848 ---
4849 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4850 running under X.
4851
4852 ** GC changes:
4853
4854 +++
4855 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4856 on garbage collection.
4857
4858 +++
4859 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
4860
4861 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4862 \f
4863 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
4864
4865 +++
4866 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
4867 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
4868 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
4869 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
4870 such things as help and apropos buffers.
4871
4872 ---
4873 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
4874 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
4875 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
4876
4877 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4878 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4879 data structures.
4880
4881 ---
4882 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4883 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4884
4885 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4886 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4887 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4888 commands.
4889
4890 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4891 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4892 SQL buffer.
4893
4894 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4895 (function (lambda ()
4896 (master-mode t)
4897 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4898 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4899 (function (lambda ()
4900 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4901
4902 +++
4903 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
4904
4905 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
4906
4907 +++
4908 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
4909
4910 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
4911 code. It works with edebug.
4912
4913 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
4914 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
4915 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
4916 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
4917 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
4918
4919 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
4920 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
4921 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
4922 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
4923 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
4924 value, such as (setq x 14).
4925
4926 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
4927 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
4928 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
4929 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
4930 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
4931 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
4932 \f
4933 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4934
4935 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4936 been added.
4937
4938 \f
4939 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4940
4941 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4942 with Custom.
4943
4944 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4945 as mule-utf-8.
4946
4947 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4948 in UTF-8 locales).
4949
4950 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4951 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4952 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4953 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4954 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4955 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4956 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4957 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4958 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4959 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4960
4961 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4962 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4963
4964 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4965 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4966 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4967 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4968 contrary to the compound text specification.
4969
4970 \f
4971 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4972
4973 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4974
4975 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4976
4977 \f
4978 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4979
4980 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4981
4982 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4983 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4984 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4985 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4986 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4987
4988 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4989 were changed.
4990
4991 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4992 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4993
4994 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4995 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4996 instead of using default-major-mode.
4997
4998 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4999 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5000 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5001 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5002 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5003 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5004 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5005
5006 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5007 NEWS.
5008
5009 \f
5010 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5011
5012 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5013 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5014 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5015
5016 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5017 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5018
5019 \f
5020 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5021
5022 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5023 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5024 charsets in this release.
5025
5026 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5027
5028 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5029
5030 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5031 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5032 to list them.
5033
5034 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5035 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5036 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5037 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5038 necessary changes to unexec.
5039
5040 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5041 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5042
5043 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5044 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5045
5046 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5047 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5048
5049 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5050 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5051 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5052 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5053 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5054
5055 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5056 new display features described below.
5057
5058 \f
5059 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5060
5061 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5062
5063 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5064 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5065 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5066 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5067 the text.
5068
5069 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5070
5071 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5072 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5073 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5074 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5075 specify a font.
5076
5077 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5078 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5079 under Lisp changes, below.
5080
5081 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5082
5083 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5084 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5085 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5086 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5087 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5088 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5089 on terminals.
5090
5091 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5092 supported on character terminals.
5093
5094 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5095 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5096 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5097 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5098
5099 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5100
5101 ** Sound support
5102
5103 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5104 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5105 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5106 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5107 sound support.
5108
5109 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5110
5111 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5112 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5113 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5114 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5115
5116 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5117
5118 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5119 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5120 specifies a number of lines.
5121
5122 Default is 0.25.
5123
5124 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5125
5126 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5127 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5128 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5129 again.
5130
5131 Default is `grow-only'.
5132
5133 ** LessTif support.
5134
5135 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5136 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5137
5138 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5139
5140 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5141 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5142 non-nil.
5143
5144 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5145
5146 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5147 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5148 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5149
5150 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5151
5152 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5153 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5154 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5155 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5156 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5157 Emacs.
5158
5159 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5160 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5161 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5162 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5163 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5164 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5165
5166 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5167 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5168 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5169 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5170 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5171 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5172
5173 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5174 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5175 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5176 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5177 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5178
5179 ** Tool bar support.
5180
5181 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5182 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5183 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5184 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5185 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5186 icons will be used.
5187
5188 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5189 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5190
5191 ** Tooltips.
5192
5193 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5194 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5195 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5196
5197 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5198 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5199 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5200 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5201
5202 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5203
5204 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5205 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5206 customized.
5207
5208 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5209 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5210 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5211 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5212 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5213
5214 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5215 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5216 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5217 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5218 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5219 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5220
5221 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5222 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5223 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5224 customizing face `fringe'.
5225
5226 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5227 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5228 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5229 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5230 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5231 the window to be partially obscured.)
5232
5233 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5234 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5235 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5236 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5237
5238 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5239
5240 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5241 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5242 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5243 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5244 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5245 have enabled one.
5246
5247 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5248
5249 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5250
5251 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5252
5253 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5254 `*') toggles the status.
5255
5256 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5257
5258 ** Hourglass pointer
5259
5260 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5261 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5262
5263 ** Blinking cursor
5264
5265 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5266 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5267 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5268 the group `cursor'.
5269
5270 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5271
5272 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5273 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5274 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5275 details.
5276
5277 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5278 have to do anything to activate it.
5279
5280 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5281
5282 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5283 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5284
5285 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5286 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5287 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5288 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5289 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5290 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5291 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5292 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5293
5294 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5295 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5296 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5297 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5298 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5299 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5300
5301 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5302 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5303
5304 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5305 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5306 buffer by default.
5307
5308 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5309 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5310 beginning and end of the buffer.
5311
5312 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5313 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5314 signaled.
5315
5316 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5317 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5318
5319 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5320 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5321 this behavior.
5322
5323 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5324 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5325 Emacs dump core.
5326
5327 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5328
5329 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5330 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5331 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5332
5333 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5334 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5335 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5336
5337 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5338 using that menu.
5339
5340 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5341
5342 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5343 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5344 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5345 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5346 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5347 whitespace.
5348
5349 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5350 all frames except the selected one.
5351
5352 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5353 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5354
5355 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5356 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5357 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5358 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5359 `Info-use-header-line'.
5360
5361 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5362 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5363 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5364
5365 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5366
5367 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5368 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5369 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5370
5371 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5372 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5373 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5374 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5375
5376 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5377
5378 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5379 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5380 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5381 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5382
5383 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5384 point in a pop-up window.
5385
5386 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5387 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5388 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5389
5390 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5391 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5392
5393 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5394 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5395 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5396 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5397
5398 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5399
5400 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5401 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5402
5403 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5404 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5405 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5406
5407 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5408 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5409 non-nil.
5410
5411 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5412 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5413 file that is already visited under a different name.
5414
5415 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5416 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5417
5418 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5419 and displays information about that.
5420
5421 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5422 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5423
5424 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5425 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5426 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5427 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5428 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5429 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5430
5431 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5432 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5433
5434 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5435 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5436 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5437 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5438 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5439 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5440 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5441
5442 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5443 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5444
5445 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5446 system for keyboard input.
5447
5448 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5449 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5450 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5451 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5452 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5453 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5454 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5455 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5456 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5457
5458 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5459 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5460
5461 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5462 displays all characters in that character set.
5463
5464 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5465 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5466
5467 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5468 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5469 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5470
5471 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5472 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5473 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5474 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5475 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5476 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5477 and Polish `slash'.
5478
5479 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5480 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5481 of the tutorial.
5482
5483 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5484 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5485 Lisp Coding Convention".
5486
5487 new command old-binding
5488 --- ------- -----------
5489 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5490 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5491 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5492
5493 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5494 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5495 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5496
5497 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5498 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5499 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5500 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5501 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5502 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5503
5504 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5505 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5506 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5507 package.
5508
5509 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5510 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5511 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5512 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5513 "`", you must type "=q".
5514
5515 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5516 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5517 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5518 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5519 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5520 on.
5521
5522 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5523 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5524 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5525 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5526
5527 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5528 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5529 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5530 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5531
5532 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5533 on the display using several methods
5534
5535 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5536 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5537 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5538
5539 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5540 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5541
5542 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5543
5544 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5545 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5546
5547 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5548 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5549 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5550 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5551
5552 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5553 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5554 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5555
5556 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5557 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5558
5559 ** New X resources recognized
5560
5561 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5562 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5563 is useful for debugging X problems.
5564
5565 Example:
5566
5567 emacs.synchronous: true
5568
5569 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5570 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5571 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5572 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5573 visual class names are
5574
5575 TrueColor
5576 PseudoColor
5577 DirectColor
5578 StaticColor
5579 GrayScale
5580 StaticGray
5581
5582 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5583 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5584 meaning.
5585
5586 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5587 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5588 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5589 visual.
5590
5591 Example:
5592
5593 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5594
5595 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5596 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5597 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5598 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5599
5600 Example:
5601
5602 emacs.privateColormap: true
5603
5604 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5605
5606 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5607 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5608 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5609 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5610 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5611 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5612 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5613
5614 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5615 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5616 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5617 `default' face and vice versa.
5618
5619 ** New face `menu'.
5620
5621 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5622
5623 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5624
5625 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5626 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5627 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5628 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5629
5630 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5631 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5632 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5633
5634 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5635 `ScreenGamma'.
5636
5637 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5638
5639 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5640 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5641 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5642 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5643
5644 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5645
5646 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5647
5648 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5649
5650 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5651 LessTif/Motif one.
5652
5653 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5654 LessTif and Motif.
5655
5656 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5657
5658 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5659 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5660 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5661
5662 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5663 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5664
5665 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5666 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5667 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5668
5669 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5670
5671 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5672 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5673 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5674 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5675
5676 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5677 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5678 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5679 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5680
5681 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5682 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5683 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5684 buffers.
5685
5686 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5687
5688 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5689 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5690 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5691
5692 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5693 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5694 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5695 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5696 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5697 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5698
5699 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5700
5701 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5702 notably at the end of lines.
5703
5704 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5705 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5706
5707 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5708
5709 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5710 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5711
5712 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5713 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5714 after each match to get the replacement text.
5715
5716 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5717 you edit the replacement string.
5718
5719 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5720 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5721 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5722
5723 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5724
5725 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5726 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5727
5728 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5729 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5730 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5731 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5732
5733 --
5734 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5735 read mail from the menu etc.
5736
5737 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5738 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5739 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5740 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5741
5742 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5743 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5744
5745 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5746 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5747 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5748 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5749 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5750 of Emacs.
5751
5752 ** Customize changes
5753
5754 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5755 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5756 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5757 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5758 earlier versions of Emacs.
5759
5760 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5761 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5762 default).
5763
5764 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5765 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5766 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5767 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5768 file.
5769
5770 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5771 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5772 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5773 already in your init file.
5774
5775 ** New features in evaluation commands
5776
5777 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5778 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5779 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5780 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5781 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5782
5783 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5784 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5785 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5786 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5787 printed).
5788
5789 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5790 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5791
5792 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5793 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5794
5795 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5796 code when called with a prefix argument.
5797
5798 ** CC mode changes.
5799
5800 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5801 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5802 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5803 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5804 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5805 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5806 release.
5807
5808 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5809 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5810 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5811 confusion.
5812
5813 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5814 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5815 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5816 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5817
5818 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5819 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5820
5821 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5822 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5823
5824 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5825 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5826 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5827 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5828
5829 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5830 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5831 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5832 earlier statement. An example:
5833
5834 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5835 if (a[i])
5836 res += a[i]->offset;
5837 else
5838
5839 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5840 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5841 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5842 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5843 the preceding "if".
5844
5845 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5846 by default.
5847
5848 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5849 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5850 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5851 documentation or other natural language text.
5852
5853 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5854 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5855 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5856 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5857 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5858 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5859 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5860
5861 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5862 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5863 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5864 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5865
5866 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5867 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5868 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5869 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5870 Pike mode only.
5871
5872 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5873 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5874 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5875 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5876 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5877 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5878 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5879 is reported afterwards.
5880
5881 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5882 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5883 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5884
5885 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5886 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5887 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5888 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5889 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5890 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5891 groundwork.
5892
5893 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5894 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5895 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5896 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5897 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5898 have to bother.
5899
5900 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5901 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5902 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5903 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5904 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5905 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5906
5907 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5908 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5909 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5910 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5911 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5912 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5913 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5914 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5915
5916 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5917 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5918 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5919 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5920 above.
5921
5922 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5923 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5924 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5925 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5926 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5927 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5928 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5929 function documentation for more info.
5930
5931 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5932 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5933 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5934 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5935 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5936 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5937 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5938 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5939
5940 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5941
5942 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5943 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5944
5945 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5946 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5947 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5948 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5949 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5950 style system.
5951
5952 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5953 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5954 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5955 as far as possible.
5956
5957 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5958 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5959 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5960 chapter about this in the manual.
5961
5962 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5963 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5964 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5965 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5966 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5967
5968 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5969 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5970 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5971
5972 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5973 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5974
5975 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5976 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5977 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5978 inside CC Mode.
5979
5980 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5981 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5982 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5983 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5984 cc-mode/).
5985
5986 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5987 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5988 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5989 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5990 they were before the filling.
5991
5992 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5993 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5994 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5995 literals.
5996
5997 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5998 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5999 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6000 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6001 this function.
6002
6003 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6004 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6005 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6006 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6007 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6008
6009 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6010 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6011 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6012
6013 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6014
6015 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6016 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6017 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6018 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6019
6020 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6021 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6022 the column specified by comment-column.
6023
6024 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6025 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6026 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6027 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6028 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6029 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6030
6031 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6032 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6033 arguments.
6034
6035 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6036
6037 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6038 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6039 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6040 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6041 Provan).
6042
6043 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6044
6045 ** Dired changes
6046
6047 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6048 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6049 is, delete only empty directories.
6050
6051 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6052 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6053 copy directories recursively.
6054
6055 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6056 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6057 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6058
6059 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6060 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6061 directory.
6062
6063 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6064 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6065 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6066 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6067 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6068
6069 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6070 from ls switches.
6071
6072 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6073 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6074 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6075 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6076
6077 ** Gnus changes.
6078
6079 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6080 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6081 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6082
6083 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6084 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6085
6086 If you used procmail like in
6087
6088 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6089 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6090 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6091 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6092
6093 this now has changed to
6094
6095 (setq mail-sources
6096 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6097 :suffix ".in")))
6098
6099 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6100 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6101
6102 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6103 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6104 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6105 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6106
6107 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6108 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6109 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6110
6111 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6112 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6113 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6114 now just a compatibility layer.
6115
6116 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6117 Gnus facilities.
6118
6119 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6120 called to position point.
6121
6122 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6123 summary buffers and NOV files.
6124
6125 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6126 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6127
6128 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6129 subtly different manner.
6130
6131 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6132 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6133 ever-changing layouts.
6134
6135 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6136
6137 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6138
6139 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6140
6141 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6142 macros
6143
6144 Key binding Macro
6145 -------------------------
6146 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6147 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6148 C-c C-c u @uref
6149 C-c C-c q @quotation
6150 C-c C-c m @email
6151 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6152 M-RET @item
6153
6154 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6155
6156 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6157
6158 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6159 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6160 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6161
6162 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6163
6164 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6165 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6166 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6167 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6168 buffers to kill, as before.
6169
6170 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6171 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6172 this way.
6173
6174 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6175 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6176
6177 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6178
6179 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6180 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6181 use. Default is 1000.
6182
6183 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6184 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6185
6186 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6187
6188 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6189
6190 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6191 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6192 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6193 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6194
6195 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6196 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6197 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6198 the open block.
6199
6200 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6201 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6202 the normal block-hiding function.
6203
6204 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6205
6206 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6207 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6208 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6209 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6210
6211 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6212 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6213
6214 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6215
6216 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6217 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6218 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6219
6220 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6221 current buffer.
6222
6223 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6224 in a log file.
6225
6226 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6227 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6228 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6229 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6230 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6231 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6232
6233 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6234
6235 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6236
6237 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6238 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6239
6240 ** Changes in Font Lock
6241
6242 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6243 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6244
6245 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6246 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6247
6248 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6249 the face used for each string/comment.
6250
6251 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6252 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6253
6254 ** Changes to Shell mode
6255
6256 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6257 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6258 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6259 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6260
6261 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6262
6263 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6264 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6265
6266 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6267 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6268 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6269 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6270 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6271 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6272
6273 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6274 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6275 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6276 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6277 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6278 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6279 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6280 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6281
6282 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6283 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6284
6285 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6286 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6287 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6288
6289 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6290 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6291 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6292
6293 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6294 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6295 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6296
6297 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6298 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6299 argument, it appends to the file.
6300
6301 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6302 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6303 compatibility.
6304
6305 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6306 ring (history).
6307
6308 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6309 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6310 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6311
6312 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6313
6314 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6315 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6316 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6317 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6318 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6319 as correspondent.
6320
6321 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6322 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6323 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6324
6325 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6326 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6327 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6328 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6329 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6330
6331 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6332 like `j'.
6333
6334 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6335 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6336 digest message.
6337
6338 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6339 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6340
6341 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6342 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6343 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6344
6345 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6346 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6347
6348 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6349 use the -f option when sending mail.
6350
6351 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6352 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6353 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6354 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6355 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6356 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6357
6358 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6359 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6360 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6361
6362 ** Changes to TeX mode
6363
6364 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6365 `latex-mode'.
6366
6367 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6368
6369 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6370
6371 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6372
6373 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6374
6375 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6376 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6377 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6378 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6379 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6380 can be edited from that buffer.
6381
6382 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6383 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6384 `A' to use all marked entries).
6385
6386 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6387 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6388
6389 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6390 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6391 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6392 been cited.
6393
6394 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6395 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6396 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6397 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6398
6399 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6400 has the following new features:
6401
6402 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6403 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6404 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6405 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6406
6407 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6408 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6409 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6410 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6411 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6412 defaults to 1.
6413
6414 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6415 file names.
6416
6417 ** Ispell changes
6418
6419 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6420 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6421 spell-checks the current buffer.
6422
6423 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6424 added.
6425
6426 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6427 correction is made and re-checked.
6428
6429 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6430
6431 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6432 cases.
6433
6434 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6435 on syntax errors.
6436
6437 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6438 end of the buffer.
6439
6440 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6441
6442 ** Makefile mode changes
6443
6444 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6445
6446 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6447 Fontlock mode is active.
6448
6449 ** Isearch changes
6450
6451 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6452 so that searches can be resumed.
6453
6454 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6455 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6456 that started the search.
6457
6458 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6459 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6460
6461 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6462
6463 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6464 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6465 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6466 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6467 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6468 `secondary-selection'.
6469
6470 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6471 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6472 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6473 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6474 usual snappy response.
6475
6476 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6477 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6478 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6479 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6480
6481 ** VC Changes
6482
6483 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6484 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6485 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6486 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6487 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6488 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6489 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6490 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6491 file is registered in that backend.
6492
6493 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6494 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6495 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6496 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6497 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6498 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6499
6500 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6501 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6502 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6503 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6504 where it doesn't make sense.)
6505
6506 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6507 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6508 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6509
6510 *** General Changes
6511
6512 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6513 checks are always done now.
6514
6515 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6516 operations.
6517
6518 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6519 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6520 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6521
6522 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6523 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6524 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6525 the working file (``merge news'').
6526
6527 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6528 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6529 downwards.
6530
6531 *** Multiple Backends
6532
6533 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6534 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6535 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6536 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6537 local RCS archives.
6538
6539 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6540 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6541 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6542 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6543
6544 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6545 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6546 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6547 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6548 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6549
6550 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6551 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6552 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6553 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6554
6555 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6556 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6557 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6558 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6559
6560 *** Changes for CVS
6561
6562 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6563 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6564 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6565 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6566 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6567 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6568 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6569
6570 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6571 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6572 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6573 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6574 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6575 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6576 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6577 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6578 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6579 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6580 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6581 name.)
6582
6583 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6584 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6585 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6586 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6587 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6588 entire directory tree.
6589
6590 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6591 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6592 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6593 "watched" by other developers.)
6594
6595 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6596 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6597 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6598 starting at the given directory.
6599
6600 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6601
6602 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6603 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6604 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6605 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6606 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6607 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6608 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6609 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6610 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6611
6612 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6613 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6614 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6615 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6616
6617 ** New modes and packages
6618
6619 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6620 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6621 the default is not applicable.
6622
6623 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6624 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6625 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6626
6627 Features are:
6628
6629 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6630 drawn, like this: | \ /
6631 --+-- X
6632 | / \
6633
6634 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6635 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6636 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6637 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6638 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6639 you are drawing.
6640
6641 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6642 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6643
6644 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6645 flood-filling.
6646
6647 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6648 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6649 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6650 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6651
6652 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6653 also do without the mouse.
6654
6655 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6656 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6657 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6658 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6659 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6660
6661 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6662
6663 lines straight-lines
6664 rectangles squares
6665 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6666 ellipses circles
6667 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6668 spray-can setting size for spraying
6669 vaporize line vaporize lines
6670 erase characters erase rectangles
6671
6672 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6673 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6674 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6675 drawing.
6676
6677 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6678 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6679 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6680 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6681
6682 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6683 can be turned off).
6684
6685 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6686 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6687 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6688 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6689 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6690 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6691 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6692 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6693 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6694
6695 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6696 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6697 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6698 on certain projects.
6699
6700 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6701 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6702
6703 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6704
6705 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6706 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6707 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6708 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6709 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6710 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6711 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6712 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6713
6714 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6715 Emacs is idle.
6716
6717 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6718 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6719
6720 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6721 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6722
6723 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6724 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6725 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6726 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6727 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6728
6729 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6730 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6731 separate Texinfo file.
6732
6733 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6734 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6735 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6736 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6737 enter check-in log messages.
6738
6739 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6740 without invoking external programs.
6741
6742 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6743 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6744 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6745 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6746 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6747
6748 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6749 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6750
6751 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6752 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6753
6754 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6755 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6756 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6757 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6758 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6759 single step.
6760
6761 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6762 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6763 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6764 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6765
6766 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6767 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6768 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6769
6770 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6771 PostScript.
6772
6773 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6774
6775 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6776
6777 ; comment (until end of line)
6778 A non-terminal
6779 "C" terminal
6780 ?C? special
6781 $A default non-terminal
6782 $"C" default terminal
6783 $?C? default special
6784 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6785 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6786 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6787 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6788 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6789 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6790 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6791 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6792 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6793 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6794 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6795 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6796 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6797 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6798 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6799
6800 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6801
6802 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6803 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6804 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6805 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6806 equal signs of assignments.
6807
6808 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6809 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6810
6811 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6812 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6813 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6814
6815 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6816
6817 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6818 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6819 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6820 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6821 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6822 which answers different needs.
6823
6824 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6825 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6826 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6827 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6828 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6829 to be enabled.
6830
6831 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6832 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6833
6834 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6835
6836 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6837 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6838 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6839
6840 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6841
6842 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6843 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6844 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6845 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6846 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6847 and background colors.
6848
6849 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6850 Pascal) language.
6851
6852 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6853 the text at point.
6854
6855 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6856
6857 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6858
6859 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6860 whitespace in a file.
6861
6862 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6863 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6864 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6865 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6866 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6867 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6868 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6869
6870 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6871
6872 Here is an example of columns:
6873
6874 horse apple bus
6875 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6876 porcupine strawberry airplane
6877
6878 Doing the following settings:
6879
6880 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6881 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6882 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6883 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6884
6885
6886 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6887
6888 M-x delimit-columns-region
6889
6890 It results:
6891
6892 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6893 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6894 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6895
6896 delim-col has the following options:
6897
6898 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6899 before all columns.
6900
6901 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6902 between each column.
6903
6904 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6905 after all columns.
6906
6907 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6908 each column.
6909
6910 delim-col has the following commands:
6911
6912 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6913 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6914
6915 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6916 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6917 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6918 recent file list can be displayed:
6919
6920 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6921 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6922 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6923
6924 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6925 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6926
6927 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6928 text.
6929
6930 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6931 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6932 specific to Message mode.
6933
6934 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6935 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6936 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6937
6938 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6939 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6940 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6941
6942 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6943 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6944
6945 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6946
6947 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6948 minibuffer with completion.
6949
6950 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6951 with the diary features.
6952
6953 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6954 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6955
6956 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6957 Fill mode.
6958
6959 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6960 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6961 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6962 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6963
6964 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6965 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6966 `.g'.
6967
6968 ** Changes in sort.el
6969
6970 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6971 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6972 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6973 numeric base.
6974
6975 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6976
6977 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6978 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6979 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6980
6981 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6982 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6983
6984 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6985 output ^M at the end of lines.
6986
6987 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6988 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6989
6990 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6991 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6992 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6993
6994 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6995 group.
6996
6997 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6998 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6999 are recognized:
7000
7001 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7002 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7003 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7004 nil -- just delete one character.
7005
7006 Default value is `untabify'.
7007
7008 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7009
7010 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7011 symbol, not double-quoted.
7012
7013 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7014 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7015 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7016 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7017
7018 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7019 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7020 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7021
7022 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7023 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7024 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7025
7026 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7027 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7028
7029 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7030 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7031
7032 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7033 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7034
7035 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7036 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7037 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7038 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7039 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7040 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7041
7042 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7043 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7044
7045 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7046
7047 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7048 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7049
7050 ** Shell script mode changes.
7051
7052 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7053 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7054 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7055
7056 ** Etags changes.
7057
7058 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7059
7060 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7061 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7062 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7063 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7064 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7065
7066 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7067 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7068
7069 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7070 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7071
7072 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7073 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7074 `template' keywords.
7075
7076 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7077 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7078
7079 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7080 types.
7081
7082 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7083
7084 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7085
7086 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7087 are now tagged.
7088
7089 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7090
7091 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7092 variables are tagged.
7093
7094 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7095
7096 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7097 for PSWrap.
7098
7099 ** Changes in etags.el
7100
7101 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7102 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7103 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7104
7105 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7106 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7107
7108 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7109 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7110 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7111 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7112
7113 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7114
7115 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7116 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7117
7118 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7119
7120 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7121 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7122 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7123
7124 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7125 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7126
7127 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7128 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7129
7130 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7131 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7132 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7133 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7134 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7135
7136 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7137 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7138 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7139
7140 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7141 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7142 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7143
7144 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7145 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7146 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7147
7148 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7149
7150 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7151
7152 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7153 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7154 expression from that list, are not checked.
7155
7156 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7157 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7158 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7159 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7160
7161 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7162
7163 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7164 displays local abbrevs, only.
7165
7166 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7167 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7168
7169 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7170 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7171 is measured in pixels.
7172
7173 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7174 to be visited as images.
7175
7176 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7177 were added to compile.el.
7178
7179 ** Withdrawn packages
7180
7181 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7182 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7183
7184 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7185
7186 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7187
7188 \f
7189 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7190
7191 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7192 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7193 See the sections below for details.
7194
7195 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7196 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7197 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7198 to remove the properties of the copy.
7199
7200 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7201 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7202 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7203 these properties are active.
7204
7205 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7206 ranges may affect some code.
7207
7208 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7209 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7210 make a difference to some code.
7211
7212 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7213 operates on the minibuffer.
7214
7215 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7216 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7217 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7218 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7219 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7220 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7221 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7222 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7223 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7224 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7225 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7226 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7227
7228 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7229 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7230 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7231
7232 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7233 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7234 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7235
7236 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7237 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7238 such as `mapconcat'.
7239
7240 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7241 string.
7242
7243 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7244 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7245 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7246 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7247 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7248 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7249 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7250 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7251
7252 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7253 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7254 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7255 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7256 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7257 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7258 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7259 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7260 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7261 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7262
7263 \f
7264 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7265 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7266
7267 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7268
7269 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7270 allows the animated display of strings.
7271
7272 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7273 interactive form of a function.
7274
7275 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7276 between custom options. Example:
7277
7278 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7279 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7280 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7281 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7282 :group 'mule
7283 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7284 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7285
7286 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7287 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7288 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7289
7290 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7291 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7292 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7293 (signal or normal termination).
7294
7295 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7296 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7297
7298 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7299 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7300
7301 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7302 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7303
7304 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7305
7306 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7307 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7308 being deleted.
7309
7310 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7311
7312 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7313 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7314 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7315 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7316 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7317 charset.
7318
7319 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7320 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7321 message.
7322
7323 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7324 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7325
7326 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7327 with the more general `:mask' property.
7328
7329 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7330
7331 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7332 backslash.
7333
7334 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7335 is running in batch mode. For example,
7336
7337 (message "%s" (read t))
7338
7339 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7340 to standard output.
7341
7342 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7343 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7344
7345 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7346 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7347 frame or window.
7348
7349 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7350 were added
7351
7352 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7353
7354 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7355 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7356
7357 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7358
7359 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7360 comparison is done with `eq'.
7361
7362 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7363
7364 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7365 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7366 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7367
7368 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7369 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7370 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7371
7372 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7373 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7374
7375 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7376 function was declared obsolete.
7377
7378 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7379 retained as an alias).
7380
7381 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7382 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7383
7384 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7385
7386 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7387
7388 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7389 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7390 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7391 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7392 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7393 means never include the minibuffer window.
7394
7395 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7396
7397 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7398
7399 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7400
7401 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7402 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7403 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7404 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7405 returned.
7406
7407 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7408 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7409 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7410 minibuffer even if it is active.
7411
7412 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7413 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7414 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7415 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7416 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7417 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7418
7419 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7420 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7421 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7422 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7423 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7424 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7425 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7426
7427 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7428 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7429 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7430
7431 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7432 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7433 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7434 Default value is nil.
7435
7436 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7437 meaning no limit.
7438
7439 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7440 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7441 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7442
7443 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7444 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7445 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7446
7447 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7448 list of a primitive.
7449
7450 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7451
7452 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7453 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7454 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7455 than replacing the local map.
7456
7457 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7458 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7459 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7460 instead.
7461
7462 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7463
7464 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7465 as promised long ago.
7466
7467 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7468
7469 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7470 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7471 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7472
7473 \f
7474 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7475
7476 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7477 regular expressions.
7478
7479 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7480
7481 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7482
7483 - Macro: rx SEXP
7484
7485 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7486
7487 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7488 notation.
7489
7490 STRING
7491 matches string STRING literally.
7492
7493 CHAR
7494 matches character CHAR literally.
7495
7496 `not-newline'
7497 matches any character except a newline.
7498 .
7499 `anything'
7500 matches any character
7501
7502 `(any SET)'
7503 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7504 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7505
7506 '(in SET)'
7507 like `any'.
7508
7509 `(not (any SET))'
7510 matches any character not in SET
7511
7512 `line-start'
7513 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7514 in the text being matched
7515
7516 `line-end'
7517 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7518
7519 `string-start'
7520 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7521 string being matched against.
7522
7523 `string-end'
7524 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7525 string being matched against.
7526
7527 `buffer-start'
7528 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7529 buffer being matched against.
7530
7531 `buffer-end'
7532 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7533 buffer being matched against.
7534
7535 `point'
7536 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7537
7538 `word-start'
7539 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7540 word.
7541
7542 `word-end'
7543 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7544
7545 `word-boundary'
7546 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7547 word.
7548
7549 `(not word-boundary)'
7550 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7551 word.
7552
7553 `digit'
7554 matches 0 through 9.
7555
7556 `control'
7557 matches ASCII control characters.
7558
7559 `hex-digit'
7560 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7561
7562 `blank'
7563 matches space and tab only.
7564
7565 `graphic'
7566 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7567 space, and DEL.
7568
7569 `printing'
7570 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7571 and DEL.
7572
7573 `alphanumeric'
7574 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7575 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7576
7577 `letter'
7578 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7579 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7580
7581 `ascii'
7582 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7583
7584 `nonascii'
7585 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7586
7587 `lower'
7588 matches anything lower-case.
7589
7590 `upper'
7591 matches anything upper-case.
7592
7593 `punctuation'
7594 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7595 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7596
7597 `space'
7598 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7599
7600 `word'
7601 matches anything that has word syntax.
7602
7603 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7604 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7605 of the following symbols.
7606
7607 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7608 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7609 `word' (\\sw)
7610 `symbol' (\\s_)
7611 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7612 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7613 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7614 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7615 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7616 `escape' (\\s\\)
7617 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7618 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7619 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7620
7621 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7622 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7623
7624 `(category CATEGORY)'
7625 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7626 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7627
7628 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7629 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7630 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7631 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7632 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7633 `symbol' (\\c5)
7634 `digit' (\\c6)
7635 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7636 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7637 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7638 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7639 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7640 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7641 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7642 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7643 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7644 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7645 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7646 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7647 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7648 `ascii' (\\ca)
7649 `arabic' (\\cb)
7650 `chinese' (\\cc)
7651 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7652 `greek' (\\cg)
7653 `korean' (\\ch)
7654 `indian' (\\ci)
7655 `japanese' (\\cj)
7656 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7657 `latin' (\\cl)
7658 `lao' (\\co)
7659 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7660 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7661 `thai' (\\ct)
7662 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7663 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7664 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7665 `can-break' (\\c|)
7666
7667 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7668 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7669
7670 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7671 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7672
7673 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7674 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7675 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7676
7677 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7678 another name for `submatch'.
7679
7680 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7681 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7682 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7683 regular expression.
7684
7685 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7686 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7687 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7688 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7689 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7690
7691 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7692 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7693
7694 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7695 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7696
7697 `(0+ SEXP)'
7698 like `zero-or-more'.
7699
7700 `(* SEXP)'
7701 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7702
7703 `(*? SEXP)'
7704 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7705
7706 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7707 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7708
7709 `(1+ SEXP)'
7710 like `one-or-more'.
7711
7712 `(+ SEXP)'
7713 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7714
7715 `(+? SEXP)'
7716 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7717
7718 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7719 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7720
7721 `(optional SEXP)'
7722 like `zero-or-one'.
7723
7724 `(? SEXP)'
7725 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7726
7727 `(?? SEXP)'
7728 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7729
7730 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7731 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7732
7733 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7734 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7735
7736 `(eval FORM)'
7737 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7738 `regexp-quote' it.
7739
7740 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7741 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7742
7743 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7744
7745 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7746 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7747 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7748 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7749
7750 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7751 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7752 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7753 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7754
7755 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7756 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7757 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7758
7759 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7760 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7761 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7762 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7763 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7764 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7765 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7766 eight-bit-graphic.
7767
7768 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7769
7770 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7771 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7772 character set as previously.
7773
7774 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7775 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7776 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7777
7778 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7779 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7780 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7781 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7782
7783 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7784 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7785
7786 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7787 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7788 "fontset-default".
7789
7790 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7791 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7792
7793 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7794 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7795 buffers and strings.
7796
7797 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7798 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7799 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7800 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7801 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7802 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7803 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7804 also been deleted.
7805
7806 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7807 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7808 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7809
7810 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7811 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7812 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7813 may differ between buffer and string text.
7814
7815 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7816 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7817
7818 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7819 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7820 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7821 `composition' from STRING.
7822
7823 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7824 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7825
7826 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7827 obsolete.
7828
7829 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7830 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7831
7832 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7833 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7834 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7835 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7836
7837 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7838 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7839 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7840 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7841 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7842 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7843
7844 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7845 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7846 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7847
7848 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7849 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7850 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7851
7852 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7853 have been introduced.
7854
7855 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7856 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7857 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7858 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7859 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7860 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7861 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7862 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7863 their multibyte equivalent.
7864
7865 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7866 that offset in the file before writing.
7867
7868 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7869 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7870
7871 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7872 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7873 from which the command was issued.
7874
7875 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7876 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7877 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7878 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7879 operate on.
7880
7881 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7882 to `window-buffer-height'.
7883
7884 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7885
7886 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7887 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7888 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7889
7890 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7891 respectively.
7892
7893 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7894 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7895
7896 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7897 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7898 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7899
7900 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7901 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7902 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7903 is currently displayed in some window.
7904
7905 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7906 argument function's results.
7907
7908 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7909 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7910 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7911 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7912 sequence).
7913
7914 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7915 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7916
7917 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7918 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7919
7920 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7921 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7922 as follows:
7923
7924 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7925 nil don't display a cursor
7926 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7927 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7928 others display a box cursor.
7929
7930 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7931 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7932 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7933 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7934
7935 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7936 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7937 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7938 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7939
7940 Example:
7941
7942 (string-to-syntax "()")
7943 => (4 . 41)
7944
7945 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7946 other than 10.
7947
7948 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7949 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7950
7951 #b1111
7952 => 15
7953 #b-1111
7954 => -15
7955
7956 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7957
7958 #o666
7959 => 438
7960
7961 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7962
7963 #xbeef
7964 => 48815
7965
7966 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7967
7968 #2R-111
7969 => -7
7970 #25rah
7971 => 267
7972
7973 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7974 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7975 and isn't a string.
7976
7977 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7978 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7979 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7980 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7981
7982 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7983
7984 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7985 for a regexp in a string.
7986
7987 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7988 `mouse-position-function'.
7989
7990 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7991 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7992
7993 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7994 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7995
7996 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7997 returns it.
7998
7999 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8000 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8001
8002 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8003 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8004 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8005 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8006 mode.
8007
8008 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8009 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8010
8011 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8012 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8013 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8014 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8015 been performed."
8016
8017 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8018 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8019 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8020 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8021
8022 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8023 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8024 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8025
8026 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8027 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8028 specified table.
8029
8030 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8031
8032 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8033 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8034 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8035 what BODY returns.
8036
8037 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8038 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8039 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8040 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8041 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8042
8043 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8044 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8045
8046 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8047 instead of being optional.
8048
8049 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8050 modify read-only text.
8051
8052 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8053
8054 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8055 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8056 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8057 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8058 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8059
8060 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8061 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8062 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8063 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8064 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8065 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8066 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8067
8068 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8069 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8070 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8071 start sequences.
8072
8073 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8074 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8075
8076 ** New function `propertize'
8077
8078 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8079 strings with text properties.
8080
8081 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8082
8083 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8084 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8085 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8086 specified value of that property. Example:
8087
8088 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8089
8090 ** push and pop macros.
8091
8092 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8093 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8094 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8095
8096 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8097 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8098 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8099
8100 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8101
8102 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8103 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8104
8105 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8106 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8107 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8108 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8109
8110 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8111 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8112 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8113 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8114
8115 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8116 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8117 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8118 or a sign.
8119
8120 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8121 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8122 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8123 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8124 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8125 space, and DEL.
8126 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8127 and DEL.
8128 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8129 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8130 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8131 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8132 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8133 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8134 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8135 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8136 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8137 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8138 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8139 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8140 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8141 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8142 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8143
8144 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8145
8146 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8147
8148 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8149
8150 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8151 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8152
8153 :test TEST
8154
8155 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8156 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8157 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8158
8159 :size SIZE
8160
8161 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8162 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8163
8164 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8165
8166 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8167 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8168 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8169 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8170 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8171
8172 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8173
8174 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8175 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8176 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8177
8178 :weakness WEAK
8179
8180 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8181 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8182 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8183 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8184 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8185
8186 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8187
8188 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8189
8190 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8191
8192 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8193
8194 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8195
8196 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8197 values are shared.
8198
8199 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8200
8201 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8202
8203 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8204
8205 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8206
8207 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8208
8209 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8210
8211 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8212
8213 Returns the size of TABLE.
8214
8215 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8216
8217 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8218
8219 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8220
8221 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8222
8223 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8224
8225 Clear TABLE.
8226
8227 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8228
8229 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8230 not found.
8231
8232 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8233
8234 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8235 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8236
8237 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8238
8239 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8240
8241 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8242
8243 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8244 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8245
8246 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8247
8248 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8249
8250 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8251
8252 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8253 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8254 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8255 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8256 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8257
8258 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8259
8260 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8261 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8262 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8263
8264 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8265 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8266
8267 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8268 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8269
8270 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8271 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8272
8273 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8274 'case-fold-string-hash))
8275
8276 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8277
8278 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8279
8280 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8281 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8282 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8283
8284 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8285
8286 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8287 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8288
8289 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8290 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8291 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8292 is too short to reach that column.
8293
8294 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8295 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8296 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8297 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8298
8299 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8300 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8301 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8302
8303 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8304 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8305
8306 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8307 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8308
8309 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8310 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8311 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8312 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8313 temporary-file-directory instead.
8314
8315 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8316 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8317 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8318 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8319
8320 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8321 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8322
8323 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8324
8325 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8326 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8327 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8328
8329 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8330
8331 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8332 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8333 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8334 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8335 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8336 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8337
8338 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8339 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8340 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8341 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8342
8343 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8344
8345 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8346 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8347 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8348 result string.
8349
8350 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8351 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8352
8353 Example:
8354
8355 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8356 (s2 "world"))
8357 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8358 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8359 (format s1 s2))
8360
8361 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8362
8363 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8364
8365 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8366 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8367 argument in it.
8368
8369 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8370 (arg "world"))
8371 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8372 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8373 (message msg arg))
8374
8375 ** Sound support
8376
8377 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8378 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8379
8380 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8381 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8382 to enable sound support.
8383
8384 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8385 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8386 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8387 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8388 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8389
8390 The following sound properties are supported:
8391
8392 - `:file FILE'
8393
8394 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8395 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8396
8397 - `:data DATA'
8398
8399 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8400 may be present, but not both.
8401
8402 - `:volume VOLUME'
8403
8404 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8405 0..1. This property is optional.
8406
8407 - `:device DEVICE'
8408
8409 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8410 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8411
8412 Other properties are ignored.
8413
8414 An alternative interface is called as
8415 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8416
8417 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8418
8419 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8420 a keyword symbol.
8421
8422 ** Changes to garbage collection
8423
8424 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8425 of live and free strings.
8426
8427 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8428 strings that have been consed so far.
8429
8430 \f
8431 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8432 Lisp Manual
8433
8434 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8435 mini-windows.
8436
8437 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8438 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8439 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8440
8441 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8442
8443 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8444
8445 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8446 image.
8447
8448 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8449
8450 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8451
8452 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8453 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8454 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8455 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8456 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8457
8458 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8459 has a mask bitmap.
8460
8461 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8462
8463 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8464 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8465 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8466
8467 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8468 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8469
8470 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8471 optional.
8472
8473 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8474 below).
8475
8476 \f
8477 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8478
8479 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8480 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8481
8482 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8483 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8484 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8485 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8486 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8487 just display it black instead.
8488
8489 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8490 a line like
8491
8492 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8493
8494 in your `.emacs'.
8495
8496 ** New face implementation.
8497
8498 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8499 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8500
8501 *** New faces.
8502
8503 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8504
8505 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8506
8507 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8508 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8509
8510 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8511
8512 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8513
8514 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8515
8516 6. Foreground color.
8517
8518 7. Background color.
8519
8520 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8521
8522 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8523
8524 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8525
8526 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8527
8528 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8529 color.
8530
8531 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8532 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8533
8534 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8535 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8536 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8537 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8538 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8539 attributes mentioned above.
8540
8541 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8542 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8543 created frames.
8544
8545 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8546 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8547 `fully-specified'.
8548
8549 *** Face merging.
8550
8551 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8552 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8553 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8554 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8555 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8556 results in a fully-specified face.
8557
8558 *** Face realization.
8559
8560 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8561 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8562 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8563 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8564 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8565 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8566
8567 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8568 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8569 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8570 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8571
8572 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8573 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8574 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8575 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8576 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8577
8578 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8579 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8580 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8581 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8582 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8583 Emacs.
8584
8585 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8586 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8587 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8588 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8589
8590 **** Clearing face caches.
8591
8592 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8593 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8594 unused fonts.
8595
8596 *** Font selection.
8597
8598 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8599 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8600 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8601
8602 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8603 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8604 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8605 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8606 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8607
8608 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8609 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8610 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8611
8612 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8613
8614 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8615 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8616 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8617 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8618 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8619 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8620 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8621
8622 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8623 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8624 doesn't exist.
8625
8626 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8627 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8628 registry.
8629
8630 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8631 slightly different.
8632
8633 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8634
8635
8636 **** Scalable fonts
8637
8638 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8639 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8640 servers.
8641
8642 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8643 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8644 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8645 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8646 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8647 that list. Example:
8648
8649 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8650
8651 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8652
8653 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8654
8655 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8656
8657 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8658 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8659 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8660
8661 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8662 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8663 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8664 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8665 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8666 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8667 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8668 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8669 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8670 of the face font sort order.
8671
8672 - Function: x-font-family-list
8673
8674 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8675 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8676 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8677 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8678
8679 - Variable: font-list-limit
8680
8681 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8682 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8683 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8684
8685 *** Setting face attributes.
8686
8687 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8688 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8689 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8690 `face-attribute'.
8691
8692 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8693 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8694
8695 The following attributes are recognized:
8696
8697 `:family'
8698
8699 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8700 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8701 and `?' are allowed.
8702
8703 `:width'
8704
8705 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8706 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8707 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8708 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8709
8710 `:height'
8711
8712 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8713 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8714 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8715 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8716
8717 `:weight'
8718
8719 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8720 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8721 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8722
8723 `:slant'
8724
8725 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8726 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8727 `reverse-oblique'.
8728
8729 `:foreground', `:background'
8730
8731 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8732
8733 `:underline'
8734
8735 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8736 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8737 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8738 don't underline.
8739
8740 `:overline'
8741
8742 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8743 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8744 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8745 overline.
8746
8747 `:strike-through'
8748
8749 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8750 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8751 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8752 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8753
8754 `:box'
8755
8756 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8757 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8758 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8759 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8760 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8761 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8762 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8763 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8764 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8765 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8766 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8767 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8768 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8769 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8770 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8771 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8772 box.
8773
8774 `:inverse-video'
8775
8776 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8777 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8778
8779 `:stipple'
8780
8781 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8782 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8783 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8784 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8785 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8786 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8787
8788 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8789 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8790
8791 `:font'
8792
8793 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8794 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8795 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8796 versions of Emacs.
8797
8798 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8799 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8800 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8801
8802 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8803 `defface'.
8804
8805 `:inherit'
8806
8807 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8808 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8809 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8810
8811 *** Face attributes and X resources
8812
8813 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8814 from X resources:
8815
8816 Face attribute X resource class
8817 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8818 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8819 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8820 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8821 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8822 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8823 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8824 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8825 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8826 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8827 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8828 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8829 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8830 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8831 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8832 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8833 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8834 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8835 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8836 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8837
8838 *** Text property `face'.
8839
8840 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8841 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8842 specification can be
8843
8844 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8845
8846 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8847 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8848 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8849 for face attribute names.
8850
8851 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8852 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8853 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8854
8855 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8856
8857 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8858 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8859 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8860 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8861 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8862 used to clear the mapping table.
8863
8864 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8865
8866 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8867 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8868 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8869 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8870 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8871 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8872 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8873 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8874 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8875 modify their color-related behavior.
8876
8877 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8878 any frame type.
8879
8880 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8881
8882 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8883 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8884 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8885 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8886 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8887 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8888 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8889 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8890 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8891
8892 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8893 display can display image files.
8894
8895 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8896
8897 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8898 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8899 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8900 `Inviolable' option.
8901
8902 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8903 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8904 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8905
8906 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8907
8908 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8909 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8910 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8911
8912 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8913 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8914 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8915 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8916 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8917 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8918 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8919 functions.
8920
8921 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8922 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8923 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8924
8925 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8926
8927 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8928
8929 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8930
8931 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8932 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8933 constrained position if that is different.
8934
8935 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8936 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8937 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8938 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8939 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8940 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8941 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8942 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8943 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8944
8945 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8946 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8947 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8948 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8949 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8950
8951 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8952 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8953
8954 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8955
8956 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8957
8958 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8959 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8960 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8961
8962 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8963
8964 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8965 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8966 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8967 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8968 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8969
8970 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8971
8972 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8973 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8974 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8975 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8976 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8977
8978 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8979
8980 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8981 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8982 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8983
8984 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8985
8986 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8987 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8988 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8989
8990 ** Image support.
8991
8992 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8993 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8994 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8995 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8996
8997 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8998 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8999 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9000 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9001 area.
9002
9003 IMAGE is an image specification.
9004
9005 *** Image specifications
9006
9007 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9008 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9009 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9010 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9011 described below are ignored.
9012
9013 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9014
9015 `:ascent ASCENT'
9016
9017 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9018 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9019 to use for its ascent.
9020
9021 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9022 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9023
9024 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9025 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9026 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9027 overlays that apply to the image.
9028
9029 `:margin MARGIN'
9030
9031 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9032 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9033 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9034
9035 `:relief RELIEF'
9036
9037 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9038 around an image.
9039
9040 `:conversion ALGO'
9041
9042 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9043
9044 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9045 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9046
9047 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9048 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9049 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9050 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9051 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9052 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9053 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9054 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9055 below.
9056
9057 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9058 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9059 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9060
9061 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9062 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9063 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9064 of the factors' absolute values.
9065
9066 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9067
9068 (1 0 0
9069 0 0 0
9070 9 9 -1)
9071
9072 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9073
9074 ( 2 -1 0
9075 -1 0 1
9076 0 1 -2)
9077
9078 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9079 ``disabled''.
9080
9081 `:mask MASK'
9082
9083 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9084 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9085 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9086 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9087 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9088 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9089 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9090 image.
9091
9092 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9093 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9094 `:mask nil'.
9095
9096 `:file FILE'
9097
9098 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9099 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9100 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9101 may be present in the image specification.
9102
9103 `:data DATA'
9104
9105 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9106 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9107 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9108 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9109
9110 *** Supported image types
9111
9112 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9113
9114 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9115 properties supported are:
9116
9117 `:foreground FG'
9118
9119 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9120 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9121
9122 `:background BG'
9123
9124 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9125 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9126
9127 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9128 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9129 instead of a `:file' property.
9130
9131 `:width WIDTH'
9132
9133 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9134
9135 `:height HEIGHT'
9136
9137 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9138
9139 `:data DATA'
9140
9141 DATA must be either
9142
9143 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9144 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9145
9146 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9147
9148 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9149 bitmap.
9150
9151 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9152 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9153 in the file.
9154
9155 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9156
9157 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9158 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9159 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9160 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9161
9162 Additional image properties supported are:
9163
9164 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9165
9166 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9167 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9168 name.
9169
9170 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9171 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9172
9173 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9174 to display compressed images.
9175
9176 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9177
9178 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9179 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9180 mono images are:
9181
9182 `:foreground FG'
9183
9184 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9185 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9186
9187 `:background FG'
9188
9189 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9190 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9191
9192 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9193
9194 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9195 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9196 properties defined.
9197
9198 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9199
9200 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9201 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9202 properties defined.
9203
9204 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9205
9206 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9207 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9208
9209 Additional image properties supported are:
9210
9211 `:index INDEX'
9212
9213 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9214 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9215 as a hollow box.
9216
9217 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9218 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9219 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9220 every 0.1 seconds.
9221
9222 (defun show-anim (file max)
9223 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9224 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9225
9226 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9227 (when (= idx max)
9228 (setq idx 0))
9229 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9230 (save-excursion
9231 (set-buffer buffer)
9232 (goto-char (point-min))
9233 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9234 (insert-image img "x"))
9235 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9236
9237 **** PNG, image type `png'
9238
9239 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9240 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9241 properties defined.
9242
9243 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9244
9245 Additional image properties supported are:
9246
9247 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9248
9249 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9250 integer. This is a required property.
9251
9252 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9253
9254 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9255 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9256
9257 `:bounding-box BOX'
9258
9259 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9260 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9261 files. This is an required property.
9262
9263 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9264 lisp/gs.el.
9265
9266 *** Lisp interface.
9267
9268 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9269 which are supported in the current configuration.
9270
9271 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9272 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9273 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9274 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9275 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9276
9277 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9278
9279 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9280 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9281 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9282 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9283 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9284 buffer.
9285
9286 ** Display margins.
9287
9288 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9289 and images.
9290
9291 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9292 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9293 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9294 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9295 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9296 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9297 of the display margins.
9298
9299 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9300 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9301 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9302 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9303 in this file).
9304
9305 ** Help display
9306
9307 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9308 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9309 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9310 that have a `help-echo' property.
9311
9312 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9313 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9314 the window in which the help was found.
9315
9316 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9317 `help-echo' text property was found.
9318
9319 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9320 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9321
9322 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9323 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9324 mouse.
9325
9326 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9327 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9328
9329 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9330 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9331 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9332 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9333 used as help string.
9334
9335 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9336 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9337 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9338
9339 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9340
9341 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9342 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9343
9344 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9345 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9346 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9347 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9348 used.
9349
9350 (global-set-key [A-down]
9351 #'(lambda ()
9352 (interactive)
9353 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9354 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9355 (global-set-key [A-up]
9356 #'(lambda ()
9357 (interactive)
9358 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9359 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9360
9361 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9362
9363 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9364 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9365 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9366 is called with one argument, POS.
9367
9368 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9369 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9370 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9371 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9372 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9373
9374 ** Tool bar support.
9375
9376 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9377 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9378 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9379 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9380 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9381 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9382
9383 *** Tool bar item definitions
9384
9385 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9386 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9387 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9388
9389 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9390 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9391 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9392 property (see below).
9393
9394 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9395 binding are currently ignored.
9396
9397 The following properties are recognized:
9398
9399 `:enable FORM'.
9400
9401 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9402 or disabled.
9403
9404 `:visible FORM'
9405
9406 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9407
9408 `:filter FUNCTION'
9409
9410 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9411 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9412 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9413
9414 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9415
9416 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9417 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9418
9419 `:image IMAGES'
9420
9421 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9422 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9423 meaning of each of the four elements:
9424
9425 Index Use when item is
9426 ----------------------------------------
9427 0 enabled and selected
9428 1 enabled and deselected
9429 2 disabled and selected
9430 3 disabled and deselected
9431
9432 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9433 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9434
9435 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9436
9437 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9438 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9439
9440 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9441 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9442 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9443 menu bar.
9444
9445 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9446 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9447 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9448
9449 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9450
9451 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9452 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9453 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9454
9455 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9456 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9457
9458 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9459 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9460 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9461 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9462
9463 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9464 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9465
9466 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9467
9468 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9469 a tool bar item. If
9470
9471 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9472 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9473 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9474
9475 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9476
9477 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9478
9479 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9480 item.
9481
9482 ** Mode line changes.
9483
9484 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9485
9486 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9487 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9488 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9489
9490 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9491 a `local-map' text property.
9492
9493 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9494 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9495
9496 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9497 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9498 `local-map' property.
9499
9500 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9501 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9502 example.
9503
9504 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9505 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9506
9507 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9508 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9509
9510 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9511
9512 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9513 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9514 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9515 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9516 line.
9517
9518 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9519 `header-line'.
9520
9521 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9522 position in the header-line.
9523
9524 ** Text property `display'
9525
9526 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9527 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9528 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9529 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9530 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9531
9532 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9533
9534 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9535 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9536
9537 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9538 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9539 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9540 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9541 simpler form STRING as property value.
9542
9543 *** Variable width and height spaces
9544
9545 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9546 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9547 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9548 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9549 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9550 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9551 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9552
9553 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9554 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9555 properties described below.
9556
9557 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9558 characters having the `display' property.
9559
9560 - :width WIDTH
9561
9562 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9563 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9564
9565 - :relative-width FACTOR
9566
9567 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9568 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9569 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9570 width of that character by FACTOR.
9571
9572 - :align-to HPOS
9573
9574 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9575 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9576
9577 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9578
9579 - :height HEIGHT
9580
9581 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9582 normal line height.
9583
9584 - :relative-height FACTOR
9585
9586 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9587 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9588
9589 - :ascent ASCENT
9590
9591 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9592 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9593 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9594 equal to 100.
9595
9596 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9597
9598 *** Images
9599
9600 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9601 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9602 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9603 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9604 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9605 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9606 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9607 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9608 as display specification.
9609
9610 *** Other display properties
9611
9612 - (space-width FACTOR)
9613
9614 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9615 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9616 integer or float.
9617
9618 - (height HEIGHT)
9619
9620 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9621
9622 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9623 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9624 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9625 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9626 a font is available counts as a step.
9627
9628 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9629 as tall as the frame's default font.
9630
9631 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9632 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9633
9634 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9635 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9636
9637 - (raise FACTOR)
9638
9639 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9640 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9641 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9642 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9643 `height' subproperty.
9644
9645 *** Conditional display properties
9646
9647 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9648 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9649 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9650 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9651 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9652 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9653 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9654 different when object is a string.
9655
9656 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9657 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9658
9659 ** New menu separator types.
9660
9661 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9662 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9663 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9664 to specify other menu separator types.
9665
9666 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9667
9668 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9669 separator occurs.
9670
9671 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9672
9673 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9674
9675 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9676
9677 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9678
9679 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9680
9681 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9682
9683 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9684
9685 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9686
9687 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9688
9689 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9690 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9691
9692 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9693
9694 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9695
9696 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9697
9698 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9699
9700 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9701
9702 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9703
9704 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9705
9706 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9707
9708 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9709
9710 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9711
9712 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9713
9714 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9715
9716 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9717
9718 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9719
9720 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9721 the corresponding single-line separators.
9722
9723 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9724
9725 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9726 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9727 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9728 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9729 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9730 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9731 default foreground is black.
9732
9733 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9734 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9735 `ScrollBarBackground').
9736
9737 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9738 settings for scroll bar colors.
9739
9740 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9741 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9742
9743 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9744 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9745 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9746 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9747 the original window start.
9748
9749 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9750 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9751 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9752
9753 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9754
9755 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9756 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9757 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9758 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9759
9760 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9761 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9762
9763 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9764
9765 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9766 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9767 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9768 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9769 temporarily to nil, for example
9770
9771 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9772 (enlarge-window 10))
9773
9774 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9775 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9776
9777 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9778 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9779 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9780 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9781 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9782 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9783
9784
9785 \f
9786 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9787
9788 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9789 input.
9790
9791 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9792
9793 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9794
9795 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9796 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9797 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9798 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9799 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9800
9801 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9802 been added.
9803
9804 \f
9805 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9806
9807 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9808
9809
9810 \f
9811 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9812
9813 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9814 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9815 \f
9816 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9817
9818 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9819
9820 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9821 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9822 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9823
9824 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9825 is the one that is used.
9826
9827 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9828 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9829 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9830 separate from the command's regular output.
9831 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9832 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9833 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9834 the buffer name.
9835
9836 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9837 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9838 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9839 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9840
9841 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9842 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9843 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9844 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9845
9846 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9847 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9848 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9849 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9850
9851 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9852 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9853 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9854 they never ignore case.
9855
9856 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9857 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9858 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9859 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9860 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9861 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9862 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9863
9864 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9865 the same format that was used in the file before.
9866
9867 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9868 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9869
9870 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9871 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9872 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9873
9874 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9875 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9876 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9877 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9878 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9879 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9880 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9881
9882 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9883 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9884 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9885 format. You can now customize these variables.
9886
9887 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9888 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9889 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9890 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9891
9892 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9893 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9894 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9895
9896 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9897 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9898 doesn't have any effect.
9899
9900 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9901 not one per buffer.
9902
9903 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9904 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9905 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9906
9907 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9908 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9909 `auto-show-mode' command.
9910
9911 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9912 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9913 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9914 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9915 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9916
9917 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9918 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9919
9920 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9921 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9922 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9923
9924 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9925 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9926 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9927 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9928
9929 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9930
9931 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9932 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9933 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9934 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9935 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9936
9937 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9938 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9939
9940 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9941 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9942 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9943 `?' on other systems.
9944
9945 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9946 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9947 Unix.
9948
9949 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9950 current codepage when it starts.
9951
9952 ** Mail changes
9953
9954 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9955 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9956 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9957 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9958 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9959 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9960 latin-1:
9961
9962 MIME-version: 1.0
9963 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9964 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9965
9966 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9967 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9968 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9969 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9970 buffer-file-coding-system.
9971
9972 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9973 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9974 mail.
9975
9976 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9977 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9978 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9979 list of possible coding systems.
9980
9981 ** CC Mode changes
9982
9983 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9984 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9985 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9986 docstring for details.
9987
9988 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9989 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9990 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9991 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9992 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9993
9994 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9995 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9996
9997 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9998 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9999
10000 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10001 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10002 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10003 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10004 anonymous classes.
10005
10006 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10007 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10008
10009 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10010 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10011 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10012 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10013
10014 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10015 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10016 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10017 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10018 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10019
10020 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10021
10022 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10023
10024 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10025 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10026
10027 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10028
10029 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10030 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10031 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10032 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10033 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10034
10035 ** Gnus changes.
10036
10037 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10038 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10039 Gnus manual for the full story.
10040
10041 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10042 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10043 group, which is created automatically.
10044
10045 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10046 values.
10047
10048 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10049
10050 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10051 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10052
10053 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10054 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10055
10056 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10057
10058 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10059 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10060
10061 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10062
10063 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10064 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10065
10066 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10067 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10068
10069 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10070 control over simplification.
10071
10072 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10073
10074 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10075 limit.
10076
10077 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10078
10079 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10080
10081 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10082 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10083 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10084
10085 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10086 `a' forces normal posting method.
10087
10088 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10089 -- `W d'.
10090
10091 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10092 to a non-nil value.
10093
10094 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10095 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10096
10097 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10098 has been added.
10099
10100 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10101
10102 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10103
10104 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10105 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10106
10107 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10108 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10109
10110 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10111
10112 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10113 been added.
10114
10115 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10116 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10117
10118 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10119 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10120
10121 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10122
10123 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10124
10125 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10126
10127 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10128
10129 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10130 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10131 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10132
10133 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10134 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10135 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10136 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10137 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10138
10139 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10140 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10141 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10142 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10143
10144 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10145 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10146 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10147 mismatch.
10148
10149 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10150
10151 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10152 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10153
10154 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10155 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10156 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10157 removed from the label.
10158
10159 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10160 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10161
10162 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10163 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10164
10165 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10166 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10167 expressions.
10168
10169 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10170
10171 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10172
10173 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10174 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10175
10176 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10177 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10178 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10179
10180 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10181 changes with a special face.
10182
10183 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10184 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10185 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10186 \f
10187 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10188
10189 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10190 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10191 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10192 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10193 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10194
10195 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10196 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10197 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10198
10199 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10200 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10201 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10202 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10203 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10204 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10205 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10206 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10207 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10208
10209 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10210 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10211 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10212 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10213 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10214 program.
10215
10216 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10217 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10218 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10219 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10220 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10221 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10222
10223 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10224 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10225 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10226 was not documented clearly before.
10227
10228 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10229 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10230 \f
10231 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10232
10233 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10234 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10235 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10236 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10237
10238 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10239 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10240 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10241
10242 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10243
10244 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10245 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10246
10247 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10248 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10249 integers.
10250
10251 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10252 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10253 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10254 file names and attributes are returned.
10255
10256 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10257 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10258 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10259 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10260 returns the result.
10261
10262 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10263 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10264
10265 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10266
10267 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10268 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10269 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10270 optionally.
10271
10272 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10273 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10274
10275 **
10276 The new function process-running-child-p
10277 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10278 terminal to its own child process.
10279
10280 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10281 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10282 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10283 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10284
10285 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10286 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10287
10288 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10289 :included is an alias for :visible.
10290
10291 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10292 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10293 to move or copy menu entries.
10294
10295 ** Multibyte editing changes
10296
10297 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10298 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10299 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10300 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10301 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10302 (setq char (sref str idx)
10303 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10304 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10305
10306 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10307 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10308 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10309
10310 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10311 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10312 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10313
10314 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10315
10316 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10317 across the boundary.
10318
10319 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10320 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10321 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10322 contains 8-bit characters.
10323 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10324 contains invalid characters.
10325
10326 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10327 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10328 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10329 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10330 way.
10331
10332 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10333 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10334 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10335 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10336
10337 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10338 compose Thai characters in a string.
10339
10340 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10341 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10342 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10343 menus should always use the third argument.
10344
10345 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10346 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10347 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10348 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10349
10350 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10351 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10352 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10353 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10354
10355 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10356 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10357 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10358 echo area contents.
10359
10360 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10361
10362 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10363 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10364 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10365
10366 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10367 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10368 means to clear out that attribute.
10369
10370 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10371 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10372
10373 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10374 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10375 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10376 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10377
10378 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10379 the gap of the current buffer.
10380
10381 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10382 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10383 current buffer.
10384
10385 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10386 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10387 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10388 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10389 \f
10390 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10391
10392 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10393 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10394 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10395 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10396 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10397
10398 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10399 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10400 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10401 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10402 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10403
10404 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10405 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10406 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10407
10408 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10409 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10410 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10411 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10412 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10413 results.
10414
10415 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10416 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10417 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10418 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10419 \f
10420 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10421
10422 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10423 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10424 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10425 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10426
10427 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10428 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10429 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10430 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10431 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10432 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10433 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10434 region.
10435
10436 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10437 selective undo.
10438
10439 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10440 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10441 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10442 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10443 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10444
10445 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10446 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10447 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10448 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10449
10450 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10451 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10452 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10453 something that most users not do.
10454
10455 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10456 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10457 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10458 applications.
10459
10460 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10461 pasting operations.
10462
10463 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10464 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10465 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10466 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10467 `ps-printer-name'.
10468
10469 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10470 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10471 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10472 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10473 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10474 hits a new word.
10475
10476 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10477 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10478 to be confused by TeX commands.
10479
10480 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10481 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10482 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10483 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10484
10485 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10486 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10487 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10488 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10489 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10490
10491 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10492 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10493
10494 ** Changes in input method usage.
10495
10496 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10497 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10498 respectively.
10499
10500 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10501
10502 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10503 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10504
10505 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10506 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10507
10508 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10509
10510 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10511
10512 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10513 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10514
10515 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10516 given in the following case:
10517 o When you are using a complex input method.
10518 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10519
10520 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10521 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10522 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10523 setting it to t is helpful.
10524
10525 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10526
10527 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10528 keys:
10529 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10530 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10531 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10532 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10533 environment.
10534
10535 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10536 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10537 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10538 get
10539
10540 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10541
10542 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10543
10544 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10545 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10546
10547 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10548 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10549 its owner and group.
10550
10551 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10552 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10553
10554 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10555 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10556
10557 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10558 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10559 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10560 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10561
10562 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10563 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10564 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10565 for writing keyboard macros.
10566
10567 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10568 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10569 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10570 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10571 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10572 info.
10573
10574 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10575
10576 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10577 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10578 contents only.
10579
10580 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10581 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10582 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10583 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10584
10585 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10586 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10587 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10588
10589 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10590 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10591 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10592 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10593
10594 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10595 failure if the command produces no output.
10596
10597 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10598 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10599 the mouse.
10600
10601 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10602 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10603 function and variable names.
10604
10605 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10606 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10607 file-coding-system-alist.
10608
10609 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10610 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10611 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10612 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10613 according to the current fontset.
10614
10615 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10616
10617 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10618 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10619 nonascii-insert-offset.
10620
10621 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10622 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10623 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10624 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10625
10626 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10627 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10628
10629 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10630 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10631
10632 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10633 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10634 command keys.
10635
10636 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10637 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10638
10639 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10640 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10641 all variables that have documentation.
10642
10643 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10644 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10645 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10646 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10647 it should show; the default is 20.
10648
10649 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10650 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10651 of your input.
10652
10653 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10654 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10655 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10656 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10657 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10658 Newly added options are included as well.
10659
10660 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10661 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10662 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10663
10664 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10665 Customize menu.
10666
10667 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10668 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10669
10670 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10671 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10672 invoked.
10673
10674 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10675 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10676 The default is 1.
10677
10678 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10679 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10680 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10681 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10682 sensibly.
10683
10684 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10685
10686 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10687 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10688 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10689
10690 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10691 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10692 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10693 every night.
10694
10695 ** Desktop changes
10696
10697 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10698 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10699
10700 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10701 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10702
10703 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10704 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10705
10706 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10707 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10708 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10709 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10710 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10711 made invisible again.
10712
10713 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10714
10715 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10716 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10717 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10718 toggle.
10719
10720 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10721 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10722 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10723 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10724 rmail-default-body-file.
10725
10726 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10727 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10728 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10729
10730 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10731 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10732 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10733
10734 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10735 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10736 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10737 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10738 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10739 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10740
10741 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10742 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10743 provided by feedmail are:
10744
10745 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10746 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10747 there is also a queue for draft messages
10748
10749 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10750 be prompted for confirmation
10751
10752 **** does smart filling of address headers
10753
10754 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10755 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10756 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10757
10758 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10759 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10760 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10761 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10762
10763 ** Dired changes
10764
10765 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10766 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10767
10768 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10769 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10770
10771 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10772 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10773 for a specified regexp.
10774
10775 ** VC Changes
10776
10777 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10778 conveniently.
10779
10780 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10781 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10782 Dired.
10783
10784 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10785 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10786 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10787 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10788
10789 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10790 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10791 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10792 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10793 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10794
10795 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10796 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10797 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10798 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10799 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10800
10801 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10802 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10803 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10804 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10805
10806 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10807 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10808 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10809
10810 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10811 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10812 session to resolve them.
10813
10814 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10815 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10816 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10817 uses as well).
10818
10819 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10820 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10821 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10822 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10823 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10824 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10825 using ediff.
10826
10827 ** Changes in Font Lock
10828
10829 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10830 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10831 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10832 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10833 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10834
10835 ** Frame name display changes
10836
10837 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10838 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10839 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10840 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10841
10842 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10843 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10844 menu.
10845
10846 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10847
10848 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10849 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10850 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10851
10852 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10853
10854 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10855 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10856 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10857
10858 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10859 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10860 the following line.
10861
10862 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10863 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10864 previously sent input.
10865
10866 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10867 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10868 as the search string.
10869
10870 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10871 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10872
10873 ** C mode changes
10874
10875 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10876 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10877 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10878 definition.
10879
10880 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10881 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10882 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10883 style is still the default however.
10884
10885 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10886
10887 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10888 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10889 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10890
10891 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10892 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10893
10894 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10895 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10896
10897 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10898 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10899
10900 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10901 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10902
10903 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10904 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10905 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10906 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10907
10908 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10909
10910 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10911 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10912 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10913
10914 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10915 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10916 expanding dynamically.
10917
10918 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10919 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10920
10921 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10922 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10923 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10924 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10925
10926 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10927
10928 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10929
10930 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10931 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10932 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10933 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10934 against the first word in the title.
10935
10936 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10937 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10938 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10939 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10940 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10941 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10942
10943 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10944 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10945 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10946 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10947
10948 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10949
10950 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10951 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10952 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10953 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10954 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10955 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10956
10957 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10958 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10959
10960 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10961 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10962 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10963
10964 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10965 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10966
10967 ** Ispell changes.
10968
10969 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10970 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10971 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10972
10973 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10974 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10975 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10976 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10977 include:
10978
10979 o URLs are automatically skipped
10980 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10981
10982 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10983
10984 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10985
10986 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10987 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10988 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10989 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10990
10991 *** New recursive parser.
10992
10993 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10994 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10995 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10996
10997 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10998
10999 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11000 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11001 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11002
11003 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11004
11005 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11006
11007 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11008
11009 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11010
11011 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11012
11013 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11014 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11015
11016 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11017
11018 *** References to external documents.
11019
11020 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11021 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11022 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11023 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11024 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11025 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11026 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11027
11028 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11029
11030 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11031 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11032
11033 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11034 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11035
11036 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11037
11038 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11039 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11040
11041 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11042
11043 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11044 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11045 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11046 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11047 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11048 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11049 more.
11050
11051 *** Support for the varioref package
11052
11053 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11054
11055 *** New hooks
11056
11057 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11058 and citations are created. These hooks are
11059 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11060 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11061
11062 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11063
11064 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11065 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11066
11067 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11068
11069 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11070 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11071 fontified, use
11072
11073 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11074
11075 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11076 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11077 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11078 directories that contain the same file name.
11079
11080 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11081 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11082 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11083 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11084 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11085 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11086 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11087 directory.
11088
11089 ** New modes and packages
11090
11091 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11092 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11093 it, but some do not.
11094
11095 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11096 code.
11097
11098 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11099 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11100 around in a buffer.
11101
11102 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11103
11104 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11105 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11106 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11107 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11108
11109 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11110 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11111 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11112
11113 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11114 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11115 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11116 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11117 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11118 the like.
11119
11120 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11121 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11122
11123 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11124 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11125 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11126 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11127
11128 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11129
11130 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11131 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11132 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11133 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11134 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11135 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11136 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11137 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11138 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11139 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11140 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11141
11142 Platform-specific modes:
11143
11144 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11145 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11146 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11147 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11148 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11149 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11150 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11151 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11152 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11153 \f
11154 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11155
11156 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11157 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11158 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11159 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11160
11161 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11162 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11163 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11164
11165 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11166 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11167 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11168 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11169
11170 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11171 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11172 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11173 environment.
11174
11175 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11176 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11177 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11178 current input method for reading this one event.
11179
11180 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11181 now control whether to output certain characters as
11182 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11183 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11184 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11185 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11186 \f
11187 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11188
11189 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11190 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11191
11192 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11193 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11194 always increases point by 1.
11195
11196 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11197 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11198
11199 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11200
11201 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11202 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11203 default value changed. For example,
11204
11205 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11206 :type 'integer
11207 :group 'foo
11208 :version "20.3")
11209
11210 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11211 :version "20.3")
11212
11213 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11214 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11215 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11216 `:version' in the top level group.
11217
11218 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11219
11220 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11221 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11222
11223 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11224 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11225 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11226 to themselves.
11227
11228 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11229 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11230 values whatever.
11231
11232 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11233 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11234 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11235
11236 ** Frame-local variables.
11237
11238 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11239 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11240 local bindings for that variable.
11241
11242 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11243 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11244 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11245 parameter name.
11246
11247 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11248 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11249 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11250 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11251
11252 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11253 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11254 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11255 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11256
11257 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11258 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11259 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11260 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11261 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11262
11263 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11264 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11265 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11266 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11267
11268 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11269 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11270
11271 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11272 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11273 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11274
11275 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11276 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11277 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11278 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11279
11280 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11281 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11282 empty input.
11283
11284 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11285 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11286 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11287 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11288 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11289
11290 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11291 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11292 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11293 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11294
11295 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11296 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11297 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11298 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11299 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11300
11301 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11302 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11303 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11304 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11305
11306 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11307 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11308 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11309
11310 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11311 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11312 was directed to display this buffer.
11313
11314 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11315 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11316 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11317 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11318 set-window-configuration.
11319
11320 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11321 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11322 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11323 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11324
11325 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11326 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11327 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11328
11329 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11330 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11331 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11332
11333 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11334 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11335
11336 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11337 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11338
11339 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11340 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11341 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11342
11343 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11344 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11345 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11346 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11347
11348 ** Menu changes
11349
11350 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11351 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11352 better supported.
11353
11354 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11355 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11356 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11357 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11358 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11359
11360 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11361
11362 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11363 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11364 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11365 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11366
11367 The format is:
11368 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11369 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11370 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11371 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11372 The supported properties include
11373
11374 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11375 item is enabled.
11376 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11377 item should appear in the menu.
11378 :filter FILTER-FN
11379 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11380 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11381 It should return a binding to use instead.
11382 :keys DESCRIPTION
11383 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11384 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11385 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11386 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11387 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11388 keyboard binding.
11389 :key-sequence nil
11390 This means that the command normally has no
11391 keyboard equivalent.
11392 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11393 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11394 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11395 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11396 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11397
11398 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11399 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11400
11401 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11402
11403 ** New event types
11404
11405 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11406 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11407 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11408 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11409
11410 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11411
11412 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11413 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11414 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11415 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11416 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11417 forward, away from the user.
11418
11419 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11420
11421 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11422 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11423 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11424 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11425 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11426
11427 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11428
11429 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11430 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11431 that were dragged and dropped.
11432
11433 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11434
11435 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11436
11437 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11438 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11439 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11440
11441 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11442 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11443 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11444
11445 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11446 in Emacs 19 and before.
11447
11448 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11449 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11450
11451 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11452 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11453 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11454 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11455
11456 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11457 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11458 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11459 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11460 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11461
11462 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11463 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11464 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11465 consistent with the new representation.
11466
11467 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11468 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11469 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11470 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11471
11472 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11473 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11474 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11475
11476 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11477 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11478 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11479
11480 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11481 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11482 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11483
11484 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11485 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11486
11487 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11488 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11489
11490 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11491 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11492 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11493 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11494
11495 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11496 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11497
11498 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11499 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11500 buffer or string being searched.
11501
11502 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11503 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11504 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11505 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11506 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11507 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11508 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11509
11510 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11511
11512 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11513 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11514 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11515 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11516 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11517 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11518 define-coding-system-alias.
11519
11520 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11521 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11522 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11523 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11524 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11525 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11526 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11527 `iso-8859-1'.
11528
11529 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11530 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11531 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11532 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11533
11534 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11535 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11536 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11537 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11538
11539 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11540 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11541 This function requires a user interaction.
11542
11543 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11544 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11545 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11546 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11547 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11548 select-safe-coding-system.
11549
11550 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11551 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11552 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11553 was done.
11554
11555 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11556 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11557 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11558
11559 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11560 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11561 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11562 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11563
11564 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11565 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11566 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11567 converted.
11568
11569 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11570 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11571
11572 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11573 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11574 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11575 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11576 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11577 range of characters.
11578
11579 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11580 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11581
11582 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11583 in the current buffer at position POS.
11584
11585 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11586 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11587 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11588 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11589 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11590 binding input-method-function to nil.
11591
11592 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11593 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11594 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11595 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11596 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11597
11598 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11599 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11600
11601 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11602 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11603
11604 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11605 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11606 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11607 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11608 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11609 \f
11610 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11611
11612 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11613 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11614 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11615 tree structure.
11616
11617 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11618 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11619
11620 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11621 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11622 in your .emacs file.)
11623
11624 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11625 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11626
11627 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11628 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11629
11630 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11631 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11632 kills the region.
11633
11634 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11635 delete the character before point, as usual.
11636
11637 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11638 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11639 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11640
11641 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11642 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11643 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11644 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11645 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11646 past.)
11647
11648 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11649 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11650 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11651 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11652 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11653
11654 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11655 and is an alias for it.
11656
11657 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11658 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11659
11660 ** Scrolling changes
11661
11662 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11663 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11664
11665 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11666 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11667 where it started.
11668
11669 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11670 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11671 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11672 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11673
11674 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11675 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11676 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11677 recenters the window.
11678
11679 ** International character set support (MULE)
11680
11681 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11682 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11683 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11684 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11685 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11686 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11687
11688 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11689 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11690 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11691 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11692 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11693
11694 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11695 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11696 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11697 language, to make it possible to type them.
11698
11699 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11700 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11701
11702 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11703 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11704
11705 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11706
11707 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11708
11709 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11710 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11711 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11712 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11713 characters for their work until they want to change.
11714
11715 *** Input methods
11716
11717 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11718 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11719 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11720 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11721 support several input methods.
11722
11723 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11724 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11725 work.
11726
11727 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11728 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11729 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11730 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11731 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11732 letter.
11733
11734 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11735 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11736 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11737 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11738 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11739
11740 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11741 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11742 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11743 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11744
11745 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11746 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11747 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11748 the first guess is wrong.
11749
11750 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11751 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11752
11753 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11754 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11755 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11756 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11757
11758 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11759 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11760 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11761 translate automatically to and from either one.
11762
11763 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11764
11765 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11766 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11767 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11768 what you want.
11769
11770 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11771 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11772 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11773 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11774
11775 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11776 character conversion as well.
11777
11778 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11779
11780 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11781 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11782 requires using many fonts.
11783
11784 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11785 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11786
11787 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11788 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11789 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11790 you would use a font.
11791
11792 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11793 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11794 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11795
11796 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11797 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11798 characters).
11799
11800 *** Defining fontsets.
11801
11802 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11803 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11804 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11805
11806 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11807 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11808 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11809 standard fontset are created automatically.
11810
11811 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11812 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11813 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11814 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11815 name is `fontset-startup'.
11816
11817 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11818 The resource value should have this form:
11819 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11820 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11821 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11822 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11823 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11824 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11825 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11826 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11827 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11828
11829 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11830 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11831 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11832
11833 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11834 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11835 following resource,
11836 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11837 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11838 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11839 Here is the substitution rule:
11840 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11841 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11842 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11843 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11844 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11845
11846 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11847 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11848 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11849
11850 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11851 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11852 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11853 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11854 fontsets.
11855
11856 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11857 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11858
11859 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11860 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11861 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11862 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11863 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11864 system for new files that you create.
11865
11866 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11867 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11868 whole Emacs session.
11869
11870 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11871 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11872 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11873
11874 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11875 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11876 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11877 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11878 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11879
11880 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11881 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11882 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11883 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11884 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11885
11886 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11887 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11888
11889 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11890 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11891
11892 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11893 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11894
11895 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11896 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11897 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11898 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11899 of the file.
11900
11901 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11902 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11903 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11904 translated into that character code.
11905
11906 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11907 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11908
11909 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11910
11911 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11912 the coding system for keyboard input.
11913
11914 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11915 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11916 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11917
11918 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11919
11920 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11921 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11922 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11923 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11924 designed to work with terminals.
11925
11926 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11927 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11928 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11929 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11930 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11931 in the corresponding buffer.
11932
11933 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11934
11935 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11936 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11937 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11938
11939 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11940 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11941 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11942 want to use.
11943
11944 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11945 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11946
11947 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11948 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11949 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11950 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11951
11952 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11953 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11954 related information.
11955
11956 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11957 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11958 scripts.
11959
11960 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11961 information about the support for a particular language.
11962 You specify the language as an argument.
11963
11964 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11965 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11966 first dash.
11967
11968 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11969 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11970 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11971 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11972
11973 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11974 B big5 (Chinese)
11975 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11976 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11977 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11978 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11979 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11980 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11981 K euc-korea (Korean)
11982 R koi8 (Russian)
11983 Q tibetan
11984 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11985 T lao
11986 T tis620 (Thai)
11987 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11988 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11989 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11990 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11991 z hz (Chinese)
11992
11993 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11994 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11995 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11996 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11997
11998 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11999 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12000
12001 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12002 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12003 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12004 Rmail files themselves.
12005
12006 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12007 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12008
12009 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12010 for sending mail:
12011
12012 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12013 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12014 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12015 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12016 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12017
12018 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12019 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12020 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12021 translations.
12022
12023 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12024 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12025 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12026 without any conversion.
12027
12028 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12029 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12030 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12031 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12032
12033 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12034 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12035
12036 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12037 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12038
12039 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12040 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12041
12042 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12043 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12044 in the buffer before point.
12045
12046 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12047 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12048 you are using.
12049
12050 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12051 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12052
12053 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12054
12055 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12056 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12057
12058 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12059 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12060 can become a bottleneck.
12061
12062 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12063 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12064 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12065 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12066 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12067 so useful that the change is worth while.
12068
12069 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12070 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12071 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12072 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12073
12074 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12075 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12076 show-paren-mode.
12077
12078 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12079 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12080 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12081
12082 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12083 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12084 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12085
12086 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12087 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12088 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12089
12090 ** Changes in View mode.
12091
12092 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12093 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12094
12095 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12096 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12097
12098 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12099 previous state.
12100
12101 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12102 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12103
12104 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12105 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12106 not just the selected window.
12107
12108 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12109 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12110 turns View mode on or off.
12111
12112 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12113 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12114 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12115
12116 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12117 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12118
12119 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12120 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12121 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12122 which version to compare with.
12123
12124 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12125 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12126
12127 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12128 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12129 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12130 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12131
12132 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12133 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12134 blocks, all of them or none.
12135
12136 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12137 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12138 confirmation first.
12139
12140 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12141 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12142 However, the mode will not be changed if
12143 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12144 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12145 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12146 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12147
12148 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12149
12150 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12151 these commands do not change the major mode.
12152
12153 ** M-x occur changes.
12154
12155 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12156 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12157
12158 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12159 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12160 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12161
12162 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12163 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12164 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12165 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12166 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12167
12168 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12169 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12170 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12171 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12172
12173 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12174 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12175 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12176
12177 ** Outline mode changes.
12178
12179 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12180
12181 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12182
12183 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12184 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12185 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12186 was already active.
12187
12188 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12189 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12190 get confused by it.
12191
12192 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12193 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12194
12195 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12196
12197 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12198 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12199 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12200 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12201
12202 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12203 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12204 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12205
12206 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12207 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12208 values.
12209
12210 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12211 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12212 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12213 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12214
12215 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12216 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12217 can be. The default value is 30.
12218
12219 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12220
12221 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12222 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12223 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12224 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12225 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12226 behavior.
12227
12228 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12229 compose-mail-other-frame.
12230
12231 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12232 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12233 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12234 buffer that shows the original message.
12235
12236 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12237 with separator lines around the contents.
12238
12239 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12240 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12241 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12242 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12243
12244 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12245
12246 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12247 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12248 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12249 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12250
12251 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12252 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12253 /etc/passwd.
12254
12255 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12256 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12257 /etc/passwd.
12258
12259 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12260 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12261 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12262 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12263
12264 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12265 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12266 be taken to be magic.
12267
12268 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12269 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12270 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12271
12272 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12273 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12274
12275 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12276 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12277
12278 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12279
12280 new key dired.el binding old key
12281 ------- ---------------- -------
12282 * c dired-change-marks c
12283 * m dired-mark m
12284 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12285 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12286 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12287 * u dired-unmark u
12288 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12289 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12290 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12291 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12292 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12293 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12294
12295 ** Rmail changes.
12296
12297 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12298 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12299 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12300 each time you run it.
12301
12302 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12303 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12304
12305 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12306 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12307 means to move in the opposite direction.
12308
12309 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12310 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12311
12312 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12313 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12314 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12315 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12316 for output.
12317
12318 ** Gnus changes.
12319
12320 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12321
12322 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12323 Gnus.
12324
12325 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12326 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12327
12328 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12329 article mode line.
12330
12331 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12332
12333 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12334
12335 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12336
12337 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12338 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12339 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12340
12341 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12342
12343 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12344
12345 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12346 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12347
12348 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12349 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12350 used to pick articles.
12351
12352 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12353 another have been added.
12354
12355 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12356
12357 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12358 generating lines in buffers.
12359
12360 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12361 `C-M-_'.
12362
12363 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12364
12365 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12366
12367 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12368
12369 *** Scores can be decayed.
12370
12371 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12372
12373 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12374 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12375
12376 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12377 the native server.
12378
12379 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12380
12381 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12382 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12383
12384 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12385
12386 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12387 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12388
12389 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12390 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12391
12392 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12393 a group.
12394
12395 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12396 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12397
12398 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12399
12400 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12401
12402 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12403
12404 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12405
12406 Use the `Y c' command.
12407
12408 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12409
12410 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12411
12412 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12413
12414 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12415 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12416
12417 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12418
12419 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12420
12421 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12422 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12423
12424 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12425
12426 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12427 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12428 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12429 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12430 this issue.)
12431
12432 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12433 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12434 particular news group. This can be done by:
12435
12436 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12437
12438 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12439 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12440 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12441 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12442 for reading and posting).
12443
12444 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12445 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12446 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12447 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12448 there.
12449
12450 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12451 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12452
12453 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12454 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12455 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12456 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12457 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12458
12459 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12460 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12461
12462 ** CC mode changes.
12463
12464 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12465 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12466 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12467 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12468 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12469 loaded.
12470
12471 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12472 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12473 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12474 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12475 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12476 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12477
12478 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12479 of the current buffer.
12480
12481 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12482 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12483 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12484
12485 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12486 style that the Python developers like.
12487
12488 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12489 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12490 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12491
12492 ** VC Changes [new]
12493
12494 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12495 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12496 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12497
12498 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12499 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12500 developers.
12501
12502 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12503 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12504
12505 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12506 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12507 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12508 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12509
12510 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12511 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12512
12513 ** Calendar changes.
12514
12515 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12516 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12517 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12518 following/previous years.
12519
12520 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12521 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12522 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12523 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12524 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12525 supposed attribute of God.
12526
12527 ** ps-print changes
12528
12529 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12530 layout.
12531
12532 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12533
12534 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12535 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12536 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12537 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12538
12539 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12540 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12541 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12542
12543 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12544 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12545
12546 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12547 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12548 printing for your printer.
12549
12550 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12551 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12552
12553 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12554 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12555
12556 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12557 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12558 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12559 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12560 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12561 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12562 The default value is nil.
12563
12564 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12565 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12566
12567 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12568 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12569 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12570 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12571 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12572 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12573 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12574
12575 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12576 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12577
12578 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12579 The default is 0 ("black").
12580
12581 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12582 The default is 0 ("black").
12583
12584 border-width Specify the border width.
12585 The default is 0.4.
12586
12587 Any other property is ignored.
12588
12589 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12590 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12591 documentation).
12592
12593 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12594 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12595 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12596 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12597 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12598 controlling headers.
12599
12600 *** Color management (subgroup)
12601
12602 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12603 color.
12604
12605 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12606
12607 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12608 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12609 background should be used. Valid values are:
12610
12611 t always use face background color.
12612 nil never use face background color.
12613 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12614
12615 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12616
12617 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12618 sheet of paper.
12619
12620 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12621 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12622
12623 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12624 each page.
12625
12626 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12627 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12628 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12629
12630 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12631 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12632 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12633
12634 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12635 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12636 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12637
12638 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12639 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12640 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12641
12642 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12643 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12644 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12645
12646 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12647
12648 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12649
12650 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12651 RGB color.
12652
12653 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12654 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12655 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12656
12657 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12658 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12659 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12660 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12661 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12662 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12663 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12664 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12665 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12666 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12667 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12668 10 + 10 +
12669 11 + 11 +
12670 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12671 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12672 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12673 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12674 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12675 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12676 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12677 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12678 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12679 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12680 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12681 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12682 22 + 22 +
12683 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12684
12685 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12686
12687
12688 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12689
12690 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12691 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12692 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12693 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12694 to "-P".
12695
12696 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12697 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12698 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12699
12700 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12701 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12702 do so.
12703
12704 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12705
12706 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12707 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12708 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12709 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12710 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12711 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12712 `setpagedevice'.
12713
12714 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12715 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12716 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12717
12718 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12719 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12720 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12721 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12722 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12723 its TO, are ignored.
12724
12725 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12726 pages. Valid values are:
12727
12728 nil print all pages.
12729
12730 `even-page' print only even pages.
12731
12732 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12733
12734 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12735 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12736 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12737 print only the even sheet of paper.
12738
12739 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12740 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12741 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12742 only the odd sheet of paper.
12743
12744 Any other value is treated as nil.
12745
12746 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12747 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12748 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12749
12750 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12751
12752 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12753 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12754
12755 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12756 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12757 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12758 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12759 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12760 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12761 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12762
12763 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12764 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12765 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12766 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12767 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12768 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12769 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12770
12771 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12772
12773 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12774 messages should be sent.
12775
12776 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12777 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12778 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12779
12780 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12781
12782 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12783 points for line numbers.
12784
12785 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12786 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12787
12788 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12789 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12790 to 2, the printing will look like:
12791
12792 1 one line
12793 one line
12794 3 one line
12795 one line
12796 5 one line
12797 one line
12798 ...
12799
12800 Valid values are:
12801
12802 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12803 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12804 is used.
12805
12806 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12807 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12808
12809 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12810
12811 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12812 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12813 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12814 3, the output will look like:
12815
12816 one line
12817 one line
12818 3 one line
12819 one line
12820 one line
12821 6 one line
12822 one line
12823 one line
12824 9 one line
12825 one line
12826 ...
12827
12828 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12829 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12830
12831 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12832 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12833 `ps-font-size').
12834
12835 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12836 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12837 `ps-font-size').
12838
12839 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12840
12841 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12842 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12843
12844 ** hideshow changes.
12845
12846 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12847 C++, ; for lisp).
12848
12849 *** Support for java-mode added.
12850
12851 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12852 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12853
12854 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12855 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12856 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12857
12858 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12859 robust and a lot faster.
12860
12861 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12862
12863 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12864 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12865 documentation for more details.
12866
12867 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12868
12869 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12870 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12871 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12872 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12873 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12874
12875 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12876 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12877 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12878 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12879
12880 ** Font Lock mode
12881
12882 *** Custom support
12883
12884 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12885 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12886 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12887 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12888 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12889 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12890
12891 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12892
12893 *** Maximum decoration
12894
12895 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12896 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12897 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12898 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12899 to get the old behavior.
12900
12901 *** New support
12902
12903 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12904
12905 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12906 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12907
12908 *** Configurable support
12909
12910 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12911 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12912 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12913 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12914 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12915 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12916 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12917
12918 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12919 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12920 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12921
12922 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12923
12924 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12925 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12926 for any mode.
12927
12928 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12929
12930 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12931
12932 in your ~/.emacs.
12933
12934 *** New faces
12935
12936 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12937 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12938 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12939 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12940
12941 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12942
12943 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12944 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12945 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12946
12947 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12948
12949 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12950 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12951 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12952 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12953 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12954 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12955 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12956
12957 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12958 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12959 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12960 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12961 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12962 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12963
12964 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12965
12966 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12967 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12968 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12969 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12970
12971 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12972 settings.
12973
12974 ** Ada mode changes.
12975
12976 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12977 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12978 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12979 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12980 stubs.
12981
12982 *** There are two new commands:
12983 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12984 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12985
12986 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12987 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12988 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12989
12990 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12991 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12992 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12993
12994 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12995 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12996 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12997 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12998
12999 ** Scheme mode changes.
13000
13001 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13002 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13003 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13004 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13005 have any effect.
13006
13007 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13008 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13009 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13010 variables as buffer-local variables.
13011
13012 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13013 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13014
13015 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13016
13017 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13018 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13019 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13020 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13021
13022 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13023 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13024 buffer in Emacs.
13025
13026 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13027 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13028 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13029 option takes precedence.
13030
13031 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13032 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13033 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13034
13035 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13036 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13037 the current defun.
13038
13039 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13040 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13041
13042 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13043 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13044 necessary).
13045
13046 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13047 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13048 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13049 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13050 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13051 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13052
13053 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13054 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13055 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13056 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13057
13058 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13059 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13060 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13061 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13062 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13063
13064 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13065 since it applies only to the current frame.
13066
13067 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13068 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13069 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13070
13071 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13072 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13073 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13074 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13075 instead of just the file you are editing.
13076
13077 ** RefTeX mode
13078
13079 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13080 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13081 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13082 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13083 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13084
13085 C-c ( reftex-label
13086 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13087 knows which kind of label is needed.
13088
13089 C-c ) reftex-reference
13090 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13091 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13092
13093 C-c [ reftex-citation
13094 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13095 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13096
13097 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13098 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13099
13100 C-c = reftex-toc
13101 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13102 can quickly jump to every section.
13103
13104 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13105 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13106 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13107 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13108 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13109
13110 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13111
13112 *** Info documentation is now available.
13113
13114 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13115 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13116
13117 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13118 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13119
13120 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13121 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13122
13123 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13124 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13125 appropriate functions.
13126
13127 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13128 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13129
13130 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13131 been cleaned.
13132
13133 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13134 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13135
13136 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13137 shall be delimited.
13138
13139 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13140 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13141 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13142
13143 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13144 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13145 prefixed with `ALT'.
13146
13147 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13148 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13149 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13150 documentation).
13151
13152 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13153 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13154 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13155
13156 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13157 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13158
13159 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13160 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13161 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13162
13163 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13164
13165 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13166
13167 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13168 from alien sources.
13169
13170 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13171 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13172 crossref entries.
13173
13174 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13175 region.
13176
13177 *** Added support for imenu.
13178
13179 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13180 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13181 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13182 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13183
13184 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13185 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13186
13187 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13188
13189 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13190
13191 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13192 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13193 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13194 as an argument.
13195
13196 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13197 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13198
13199 ** browse-url changes
13200
13201 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13202 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13203 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13204 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13205 customization variables.
13206
13207 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13208
13209 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13210 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13211 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13212
13213 ** Changes in Ediff
13214
13215 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13216 pops up the Info file for this command.
13217
13218 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13219 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13220 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13221 directories).
13222
13223 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13224 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13225 files in the same directory.
13226
13227 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13228 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13229 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13230
13231 ** Changes in Viper
13232
13233 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13234 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13235 instead of vip-.
13236 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13237 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13238 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13239 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13240 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13241 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13242 color when Viper is in insert state.
13243 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13244 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13245 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13246
13247 ** Etags changes.
13248
13249 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13250 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13251 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13252 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13253 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13254
13255 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13256
13257 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13258 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13259
13260 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13261 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13262 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13263
13264 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13265 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13266 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13267 methods and protocols.
13268
13269 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13270 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13271 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13272 paragraph name.
13273
13274 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13275 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13276 at least M times and as many as N times.
13277
13278 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13279 in files has changed slightly.
13280
13281 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13282 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13283 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13284 with old time-stamp-format values.
13285
13286 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13287 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13288 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13289 reasons.
13290
13291 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13292 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13293 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13294 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13295 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13296 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13297
13298 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13299 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13300 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13301
13302 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13303 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13304 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13305 recommended now will continue to work then.
13306
13307 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13308 details.
13309
13310 ** There are some additional major modes:
13311
13312 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13313 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13314 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13315
13316 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13317 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13318 into Emacs.
13319
13320 ** New Lisp packages include:
13321
13322 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13323
13324 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13325 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13326
13327 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13328
13329 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13330 in shell buffers.
13331
13332 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13333 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13334 and `elint-defun'.
13335
13336 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13337 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13338 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13339 strings or comments.
13340
13341 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13342 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13343 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13344 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13345 at these points.
13346
13347 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13348 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13349
13350 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13351 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13352
13353 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13354
13355 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13356 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13357
13358 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13359
13360 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13361
13362 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13363
13364 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13365 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13366
13367 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13368 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13369 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13370 original place after inserting the copy.
13371
13372 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13373 on the buffer.
13374
13375 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13376 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13377 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13378
13379 Enable mouse-drag with:
13380 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13381 -or-
13382 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13383
13384 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13385 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13386
13387 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13388 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13389
13390 *** ogonek
13391
13392 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13393 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13394 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13395 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13396 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13397 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13398 instance) and vice versa.
13399
13400 To use this package load it using
13401 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13402 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13403 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13404 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13405 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13406 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13407
13408 *** Interface to ph.
13409
13410 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13411
13412 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13413 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13414 these servers.
13415
13416 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13417
13418 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13419 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13420 while the real cursor does not move.
13421
13422 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13423 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13424
13425 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13426 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13427
13428 ** movemail change
13429
13430 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13431 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13432 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13433 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13434
13435 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13436 \f
13437 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13438
13439 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13440
13441 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13442 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13443 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13444 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13445 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13446
13447 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13448 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13449 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13450 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13451 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13452 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13453 \f
13454 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13455
13456 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13457 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13458 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13459 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13460
13461 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13462 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13463
13464 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13465 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13466 "win".
13467
13468 ** Basic Lisp changes
13469
13470 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13471 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13472
13473 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13474 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13475 or by the user.
13476
13477 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13478
13479 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13480
13481 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13482 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13483
13484 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13485 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13486 its argument.
13487
13488 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13489
13490 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13491
13492 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13493
13494 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13495 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13496 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13497 `format' function.
13498
13499 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13500 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13501 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13502
13503 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13504 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13505 adding one of these suffixes.
13506
13507 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13508 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13509 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13510
13511 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13512 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13513
13514 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13515
13516 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13517 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13518
13519 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13520 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13521
13522 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13523
13524 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13525 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13526
13527 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13528 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13529 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13530 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13531
13532 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13533 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13534 of the last form.
13535
13536 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13537 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13538 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13539 as the last form.
13540
13541 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13542 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13543 matches.
13544
13545 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13546
13547 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13548 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13549 Then it returns that string.
13550
13551 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13552
13553 (with-output-to-string
13554 (princ "The buffer is ")
13555 (princ (buffer-name)))
13556
13557 returns "The buffer is foo".
13558
13559 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13560 is non-nil.
13561
13562 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13563 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13564 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13565
13566 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13567 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13568
13569 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13570 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13571 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13572 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13573 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13574 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13575
13576 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13577 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13578 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13579 characters".
13580
13581 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13582 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13583 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13584 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13585 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13586
13587 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13588 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13589 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13590 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13591
13592 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13593 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13594
13595 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13596
13597 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13598 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13599 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13600 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13601 guaranteed.
13602
13603 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13604 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13605 character).
13606
13607 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13608
13609 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13610 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13611 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13612 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13613 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13614
13615 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13616
13617 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13618 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13619 more than the number of characters.
13620
13621 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13622 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13623 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13624 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13625 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13626 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13627
13628 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13629 and returns a string containing those characters.
13630
13631 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13632 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13633 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13634 character, sref signals an error.
13635
13636 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13637 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13638 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13639
13640 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13641 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13642 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13643
13644 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13645 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13646 to a vector of the characters in it.
13647
13648 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13649 of a string. You call it as follows:
13650
13651 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13652
13653 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13654 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13655 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13656 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13657 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13658
13659 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13660 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13661
13662 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13663 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13664
13665 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13666 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13667 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13668 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13669
13670 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13671
13672 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13673
13674 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13675 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13676 are not included in the resulting value.
13677
13678 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13679 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13680 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13681 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13682
13683 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13684 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13685 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13686 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13687 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13688 column START-COLUMN.
13689
13690 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13691 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13692 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13693 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13694 changed text, before the change.
13695
13696 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13697 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13698 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13699
13700 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13701
13702 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13703
13704 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13705 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13706
13707 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13708 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13709 which identify the character within that character set.
13710
13711 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13712 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13713 opposite of split-char.
13714
13715 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13716 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13717
13718 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13719 of all the characters in a string.
13720
13721 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13722 and specifying coding systems.
13723
13724 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13725 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13726 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13727 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13728 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13729 as what to do about code conversion.)
13730
13731 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13732 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13733
13734 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13735 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13736 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13737
13738 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13739 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13740 to match against a file name.
13741
13742 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13743 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13744 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13745 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13746 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13747 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13748
13749 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13750 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13751
13752 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13753 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13754
13755 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13756 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13757 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13758 service names.
13759
13760 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13761 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13762 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13763 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13764 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13765 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13766
13767 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13768 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13769
13770 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13771 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13772 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13773 start the subprocess.
13774
13775 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13776 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13777 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13778 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13779 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13780
13781 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13782 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13783 subprocess.
13784
13785 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13786 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13787 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13788 connection permanently or until overridden.
13789
13790 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13791 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13792 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13793 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13794 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13795 system for one operation at a time.
13796
13797 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13798 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13799
13800 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13801 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13802 The value is a cons cell,
13803 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13804 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13805 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13806 input to the subprocess.
13807
13808 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13809 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13810
13811 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13812 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13813 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13814
13815 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13816 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13817 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13818 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13819 customization.
13820
13821 Thus, instead of writing
13822
13823 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13824 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13825
13826 you would now write this:
13827
13828 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13829 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13830 :type 'boolean
13831 :group foo)
13832
13833 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13834 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13835 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13836 for a description of them.
13837
13838 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13839 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13840
13841 (defgroup ispell nil
13842 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13843 :group 'processes)
13844
13845 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13846 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13847 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13848 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13849 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13850
13851 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13852 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13853 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13854 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13855 first-level subgroups.
13856
13857 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13858
13859 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13860 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13861
13862 ** easy-mmode
13863
13864 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13865 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13866 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13867 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13868 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13869 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13870
13871 ** Text property changes
13872
13873 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13874 text property.
13875
13876 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13877 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13878 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13879 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13880 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13881
13882 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13883 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13884 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13885 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13886
13887 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13888 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13889 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13890
13891 ** Changes in invisibility features
13892
13893 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13894 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13895 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13896 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13897 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13898 make the overlay visible.
13899
13900 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13901 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13902 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13903 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13904 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13905 t when it should hide it.
13906
13907 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13908
13909 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13910 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13911 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13912 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13913 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13914 Here is an example of how to do this:
13915
13916 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13917 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13918 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13919 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13920
13921 ...
13922 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13923
13924 ...
13925 ;; When done with the overlays:
13926 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13927 ;; Or respectively:
13928 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13929
13930 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13931
13932 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13933 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13934 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13935 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13936
13937 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13938 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13939 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13940
13941 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13942 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13943
13944 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13945 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13946
13947 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13948 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13949 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13950
13951 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13952 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13953 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13954 determine the syntax type of the character.
13955
13956 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13957 of the current buffer.
13958
13959 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13960 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13961 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13962
13963 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13964 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13965 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13966 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13967 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13968
13969 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13970 text property.
13971
13972 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13973 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13974 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13975
13976 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13977 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13978 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13979 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13980 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13981
13982 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13983 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13984 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13985
13986 ** Changes in face features
13987
13988 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13989 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13990
13991 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13992 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13993
13994 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13995 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13996
13997 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13998 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13999
14000 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14001 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14002 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14003 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14004 overlay property).
14005
14006 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14007 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14008
14009 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14010
14011 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14012 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14013 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14014 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14015
14016 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14017 begins with ~.
14018
14019 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14020 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14021
14022 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14023 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14024
14025 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14026 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14027
14028 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14029 character code conversion as well as other things.
14030
14031 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14032 (formerly it did not).
14033
14034 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14035 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14036
14037 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14038 instead of constant strings.
14039
14040 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14041 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14042 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14043
14044 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14045 in the same way as before.
14046
14047 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14048 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14049 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14050
14051 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14052 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14053 else, and returns nil.
14054
14055 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14056 directory cannot be listed.
14057
14058 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14059
14060 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14061 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14062 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14063 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14064 ways:
14065
14066 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14067 It is available through the history command M-n.
14068
14069 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14070 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14071 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14072 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14073 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14074
14075 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14076 argument in this way.
14077
14078 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14079 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14080 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14081
14082 ** Echo area features
14083
14084 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14085 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14086 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14087 after the echo area is cleared.
14088
14089 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14090 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14091
14092 ** Keyboard input features
14093
14094 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14095 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14096
14097 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14098 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14099 by keyboard macros.
14100
14101 ** Frame-related changes
14102
14103 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14104 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14105 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14106
14107 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14108 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14109 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14110
14111 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14112 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14113 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14114 in the selected frame.
14115
14116 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14117 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14118 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14119
14120 ** X Windows features
14121
14122 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14123 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14124 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14125
14126 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14127 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14128
14129 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14130 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14131 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14132
14133 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14134 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14135
14136 ** Subprocess features
14137
14138 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14139 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14140 automatically.
14141
14142 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14143 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14144
14145 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14146 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14147
14148 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14149 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14150
14151 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14152 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14153 goes after the other menu items.
14154
14155 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14156 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14157 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14158 are in use.
14159
14160 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14161 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14162
14163 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14164 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14165 form.
14166
14167 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14168 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14169 but its hook is still run.
14170
14171 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14172 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14173
14174 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14175 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14176 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14177
14178 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14179 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14180 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14181 warned.
14182
14183 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14184 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14185
14186 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14187 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14188 functions like display-time.
14189
14190 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14191 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14192
14193 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14194 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14195 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14196
14197 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14198 if there is an error in compilation.
14199
14200 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14201 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14202 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14203 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14204
14205 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14206 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14207 the *scratch* buffer.
14208
14209 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14210 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14211 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14212 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14213
14214 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14215 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14216 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14217
14218 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14219 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14220 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14221 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14222
14223 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14224 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14225 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14226
14227 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14228 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14229 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14230 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14231 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14232 files at all.
14233
14234 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14235 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14236 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14237 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14238
14239 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14240 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14241 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14242 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14243
14244 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14245
14246 ** imenu.el changes.
14247
14248 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14249 item from menu created by imenu.
14250
14251 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14252 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14253 select one of those items.
14254 \f
14255 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14256
14257 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14258 Copyright information:
14259
14260 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14261
14262 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14263 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14264 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14265 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14266
14267 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14268 of this document, or of portions of it,
14269 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14270 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14271 \f
14272 Local variables:
14273 mode: outline
14274 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14275 end:
14276
14277 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793